gcompris r3584 - in branches/gcomprixogoo: . docs/C src/administration-activity src/administration-activity/admin src/boards



Author: bcoudoin
Date: Mon Oct 27 21:00:29 2008
New Revision: 3584
URL: http://svn.gnome.org/viewvc/gcompris?rev=3584&view=rev

Log:
better placement of the bar in the administration mode


Modified:
   branches/gcomprixogoo/COPYING
   branches/gcomprixogoo/INSTALL
   branches/gcomprixogoo/docs/C/texinfo.tex
   branches/gcomprixogoo/install-sh
   branches/gcomprixogoo/src/administration-activity/admin/module.py
   branches/gcomprixogoo/src/administration-activity/administration.py
   branches/gcomprixogoo/src/boards/py-mod-gcompris.c

Modified: branches/gcomprixogoo/COPYING
==============================================================================
--- branches/gcomprixogoo/COPYING	(original)
+++ branches/gcomprixogoo/COPYING	Mon Oct 27 21:00:29 2008
@@ -1,626 +1,285 @@
-                    GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
-                       Version 3, 29 June 2007
+		    GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
+		       Version 2, June 1991
 
- Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/>
+ Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+     59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA  02111-1307  USA
  Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
  of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
 
-                            Preamble
+			    Preamble
 
-  The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for
-software and other kinds of works.
-
-  The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed
-to take away your freedom to share and change the works.  By contrast,
-the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to
-share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free
-software for all its users.  We, the Free Software Foundation, use the
-GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to
-any other work released this way by its authors.  You can apply it to
+  The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
+freedom to share and change it.  By contrast, the GNU General Public
+License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
+software--to make sure the software is free for all its users.  This
+General Public License applies to most of the Free Software
+Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to
+using it.  (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by
+the GNU Library General Public License instead.)  You can apply it to
 your programs, too.
 
   When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
 price.  Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
 have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
-them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you
-want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new
-free programs, and that you know you can do these things.
-
-  To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you
-these rights or asking you to surrender the rights.  Therefore, you have
-certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if
-you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others.
+this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it
+if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it
+in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
+
+  To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
+anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
+These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
+distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
 
   For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
-gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same
-freedoms that you received.  You must make sure that they, too, receive
-or can get the source code.  And you must show them these terms so they
-know their rights.
-
-  Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps:
-(1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License
-giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it.
-
-  For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains
-that there is no warranty for this free software.  For both users' and
-authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as
-changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to
-authors of previous versions.
-
-  Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run
-modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer
-can do so.  This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of
-protecting users' freedom to change the software.  The systematic
-pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to
-use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable.  Therefore, we
-have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those
-products.  If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we
-stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions
-of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users.
-
-  Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents.
-States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of
-software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to
-avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could
-make it effectively proprietary.  To prevent this, the GPL assures that
-patents cannot be used to render the program non-free.
+gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
+you have.  You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
+source code.  And you must show them these terms so they know their
+rights.
+
+  We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
+(2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy,
+distribute and/or modify the software.
+
+  Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain
+that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free
+software.  If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we
+want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so
+that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original
+authors' reputations.
+
+  Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software
+patents.  We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free
+program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the
+program proprietary.  To prevent this, we have made it clear that any
+patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
 
   The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
 modification follow.
-
-                       TERMS AND CONDITIONS
-
-  0. Definitions.
-
-  "This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License.
-
-  "Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of
-works, such as semiconductor masks.
-
-  "The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this
-License.  Each licensee is addressed as "you".  "Licensees" and
-"recipients" may be individuals or organizations.
-
-  To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work
-in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an
-exact copy.  The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the
-earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work.
-
-  A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based
-on the Program.
-
-  To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without
-permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for
-infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a
-computer or modifying a private copy.  Propagation includes copying,
-distribution (with or without modification), making available to the
-public, and in some countries other activities as well.
-
-  To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other
-parties to make or receive copies.  Mere interaction with a user through
-a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying.
-
-  An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices"
-to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible
-feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2)
-tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the
-extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the
-work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License.  If
-the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a
-menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion.
-
-  1. Source Code.
-
-  The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work
-for making modifications to it.  "Object code" means any non-source
-form of a work.
-
-  A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official
-standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of
-interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that
-is widely used among developers working in that language.
-
-  The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other
-than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of
-packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major
-Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that
-Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an
-implementation is available to the public in source code form.  A
-"Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component
-(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system
-(if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to
-produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it.
-
-  The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all
-the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable
-work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to
-control those activities.  However, it does not include the work's
-System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free
-programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but
-which are not part of the work.  For example, Corresponding Source
-includes interface definition files associated with source files for
-the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically
-linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require,
-such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those
-subprograms and other parts of the work.
-
-  The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users
-can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding
-Source.
-
-  The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that
-same work.
-
-  2. Basic Permissions.
-
-  All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of
-copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated
-conditions are met.  This License explicitly affirms your unlimited
-permission to run the unmodified Program.  The output from running a
-covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its
-content, constitutes a covered work.  This License acknowledges your
-rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law.
-
-  You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not
-convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains
-in force.  You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose
-of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you
-with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with
-the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do
-not control copyright.  Those thus making or running the covered works
-for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction
-and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of
-your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you.
-
-  Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under
-the conditions stated below.  Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10
-makes it unnecessary.
-
-  3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law.
-
-  No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological
-measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article
-11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or
-similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such
-measures.
-
-  When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid
-circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention
-is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to
-the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or
-modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's
-users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of
-technological measures.
-
-  4. Conveying Verbatim Copies.
-
-  You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you
-receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
-appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice;
-keep intact all notices stating that this License and any
-non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code;
-keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all
-recipients a copy of this License along with the Program.
-
-  You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey,
-and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee.
-
-  5. Conveying Modified Source Versions.
-
-  You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to
-produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the
-terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
-
-    a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified
-    it, and giving a relevant date.
-
-    b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is
-    released under this License and any conditions added under section
-    7.  This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to
-    "keep intact all notices".
-
-    c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this
-    License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy.  This
-    License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7
-    additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts,
-    regardless of how they are packaged.  This License gives no
-    permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not
-    invalidate such permission if you have separately received it.
-
-    d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display
-    Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive
-    interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your
-    work need not make them do so.
-
-  A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent
-works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work,
-and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program,
-in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an
-"aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not
-used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users
-beyond what the individual works permit.  Inclusion of a covered work
-in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other
-parts of the aggregate.
-
-  6. Conveying Non-Source Forms.
-
-  You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms
-of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the
-machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License,
-in one of these ways:
-
-    a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product
-    (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the
-    Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium
-    customarily used for software interchange.
-
-    b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product
-    (including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a
-    written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as
-    long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product
-    model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a
-    copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the
-    product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical
-    medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no
-    more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this
-    conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the
-    Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge.
-
-    c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the
-    written offer to provide the Corresponding Source.  This
-    alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and
-    only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord
-    with subsection 6b.
-
-    d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated
-    place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the
-    Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no
-    further charge.  You need not require recipients to copy the
-    Corresponding Source along with the object code.  If the place to
-    copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source
-    may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party)
-    that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain
-    clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the
-    Corresponding Source.  Regardless of what server hosts the
-    Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is
-    available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements.
-
-    e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided
-    you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding
-    Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no
-    charge under subsection 6d.
-
-  A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded
-from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be
-included in conveying the object code work.
-
-  A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any
-tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family,
-or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation
-into a dwelling.  In determining whether a product is a consumer product,
-doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage.  For a particular
-product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a
-typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status
-of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user
-actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product.  A product
-is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial
-commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent
-the only significant mode of use of the product.
-
-  "Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods,
-procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install
-and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from
-a modified version of its Corresponding Source.  The information must
-suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object
-code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because
-modification has been made.
-
-  If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or
-specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as
-part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the
-User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a
-fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the
-Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied
-by the Installation Information.  But this requirement does not apply
-if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install
-modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has
-been installed in ROM).
-
-  The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a
-requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates
-for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for
-the User Product in which it has been modified or installed.  Access to a
-network may be denied when the modification itself materially and
-adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and
-protocols for communication across the network.
-
-  Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided,
-in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly
-documented (and with an implementation available to the public in
-source code form), and must require no special password or key for
-unpacking, reading or copying.
-
-  7. Additional Terms.
-
-  "Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this
-License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions.
-Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall
-be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent
-that they are valid under applicable law.  If additional permissions
-apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately
-under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by
-this License without regard to the additional permissions.
-
-  When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option
-remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of
-it.  (Additional permissions may be written to require their own
-removal in certain cases when you modify the work.)  You may place
-additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work,
-for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission.
-
-  Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you
-add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of
-that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms:
-
-    a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the
-    terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or
-
-    b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or
-    author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal
-    Notices displayed by works containing it; or
-
-    c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or
-    requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in
-    reasonable ways as different from the original version; or
-
-    d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or
-    authors of the material; or
-
-    e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some
-    trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or
-
-    f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that
-    material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of
-    it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for
-    any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on
-    those licensors and authors.
-
-  All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further
-restrictions" within the meaning of section 10.  If the Program as you
-received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is
-governed by this License along with a term that is a further
-restriction, you may remove that term.  If a license document contains
-a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this
-License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms
-of that license document, provided that the further restriction does
-not survive such relicensing or conveying.
-
-  If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you
-must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the
-additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating
-where to find the applicable terms.
-
-  Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the
-form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions;
-the above requirements apply either way.
-
-  8. Termination.
-
-  You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly
-provided under this License.  Any attempt otherwise to propagate or
-modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under
-this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third
-paragraph of section 11).
-
-  However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your
-license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a)
-provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and
-finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright
-holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means
-prior to 60 days after the cessation.
-
-  Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is
-reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the
-violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have
-received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that
-copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after
-your receipt of the notice.
-
-  Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the
-licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under
-this License.  If your rights have been terminated and not permanently
-reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same
-material under section 10.
-
-  9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies.
-
-  You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or
-run a copy of the Program.  Ancillary propagation of a covered work
-occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission
-to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance.  However,
-nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or
-modify any covered work.  These actions infringe copyright if you do
-not accept this License.  Therefore, by modifying or propagating a
-covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so.
-
-  10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients.
-
-  Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically
-receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and
-propagate that work, subject to this License.  You are not responsible
-for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License.
-
-  An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an
-organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an
-organization, or merging organizations.  If propagation of a covered
-work results from an entity transaction, each party to that
-transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever
-licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could
-give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the
-Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if
-the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts.
-
-  You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the
-rights granted or affirmed under this License.  For example, you may
-not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of
-rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation
-(including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that
-any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for
-sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it.
-
-  11. Patents.
-
-  A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this
-License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based.  The
-work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version".
-
-  A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims
-owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or
-hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted
-by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version,
-but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a
-consequence of further modification of the contributor version.  For
-purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant
-patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of
+
+		    GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
+   TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
+
+  0. This License applies to any program or other work which contains
+a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed
+under the terms of this General Public License.  The "Program", below,
+refers to any such program or work, and a "work based on the Program"
+means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law:
+that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it,
+either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another
+language.  (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in
+the term "modification".)  Each licensee is addressed as "you".
+
+Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
+covered by this License; they are outside its scope.  The act of
+running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program
+is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the
+Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
+Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
+
+  1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's
+source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you
+conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
+copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the
+notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty;
+and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License
+along with the Program.
+
+You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and
+you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
+
+  2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion
+of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and
+distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
+above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
+
+    a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices
+    stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
+
+    b) You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in
+    whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any
+    part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third
+    parties under the terms of this License.
+
+    c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively
+    when run, you must cause it, when started running for such
+    interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an
+    announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a
+    notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide
+    a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under
+    these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this
+    License.  (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but
+    does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on
+    the Program is not required to print an announcement.)
+
+These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole.  If
+identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program,
+and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
+themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
+sections when you distribute them as separate works.  But when you
+distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
+on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
+this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
+entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it.
+
+Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
+your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
+exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
+collective works based on the Program.
+
+In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program
+with the Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of
+a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
+the scope of this License.
+
+  3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it,
+under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
+Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
+
+    a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
+    source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections
+    1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
+
+    b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
+    years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your
+    cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete
+    machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be
+    distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
+    customarily used for software interchange; or,
+
+    c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer
+    to distribute corresponding source code.  (This alternative is
+    allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
+    received the program in object code or executable form with such
+    an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.)
+
+The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for
+making modifications to it.  For an executable work, complete source
+code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any
+associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to
+control compilation and installation of the executable.  However, as a
+special exception, the source code distributed need not include
+anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary
+form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the
+operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component
+itself accompanies the executable.
+
+If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering
+access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent
+access to copy the source code from the same place counts as
+distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not
+compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
+
+  4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program
+except as expressly provided under this License.  Any attempt
+otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is
+void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
+However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under
+this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
+parties remain in full compliance.
+
+  5. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
+signed it.  However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
+distribute the Program or its derivative works.  These actions are
+prohibited by law if you do not accept this License.  Therefore, by
+modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the
+Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
+all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
+the Program or works based on it.
+
+  6. Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
+Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
+original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to
+these terms and conditions.  You may not impose any further
+restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
+You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to
 this License.
 
-  Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free
-patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to
-make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and
-propagate the contents of its contributor version.
-
-  In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express
-agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent
-(such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to
-sue for patent infringement).  To "grant" such a patent license to a
-party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a
-patent against the party.
-
-  If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license,
-and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone
-to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a
-publicly available network server or other readily accessible means,
-then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so
-available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the
-patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner
-consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent
-license to downstream recipients.  "Knowingly relying" means you have
-actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the
-covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work
-in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that
-country that you have reason to believe are valid.
-
-  If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or
-arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a
-covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties
-receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify
-or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license
-you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered
-work and works based on it.
-
-  A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within
-the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is
-conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are
-specifically granted under this License.  You may not convey a covered
-work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is
-in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment
-to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying
-the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the
-parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory
-patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work
-conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily
-for and in connection with specific products or compilations that
-contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement,
-or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007.
-
-  Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting
-any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may
-otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law.
-
-  12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom.
-
-  If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
+  7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
+infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
+conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
 otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
-excuse you from the conditions of this License.  If you cannot convey a
-covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
-License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may
-not convey it at all.  For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you
-to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey
-the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this
-License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program.
-
-  13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License.
-
-  Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have
-permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed
-under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single
-combined work, and to convey the resulting work.  The terms of this
-License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work,
-but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License,
-section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the
-combination as such.
-
-  14. Revised Versions of this License.
+excuse you from the conditions of this License.  If you cannot
+distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
+License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
+may not distribute the Program at all.  For example, if a patent
+license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by
+all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
+the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
+refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
+
+If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under
+any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to
+apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
+circumstances.
+
+It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
+patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
+such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
+integrity of the free software distribution system, which is
+implemented by public license practices.  Many people have made
+generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
+through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
+system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
+to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
+impose that choice.
+
+This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
+be a consequence of the rest of this License.
+
+  8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in
+certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
+original copyright holder who places the Program under this License
+may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
+those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among
+countries not thus excluded.  In such case, this License incorporates
+the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
 
-  The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of
-the GNU General Public License from time to time.  Such new versions will
+  9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions
+of the General Public License from time to time.  Such new versions will
 be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
 address new problems or concerns.
 
-  Each version is given a distinguishing version number.  If the
-Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General
-Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the
-option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered
-version or of any later version published by the Free Software
-Foundation.  If the Program does not specify a version number of the
-GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published
-by the Free Software Foundation.
-
-  If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future
-versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's
-public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you
-to choose that version for the Program.
-
-  Later license versions may give you additional or different
-permissions.  However, no additional obligations are imposed on any
-author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a
-later version.
-
-  15. Disclaimer of Warranty.
-
-  THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
-APPLICABLE LAW.  EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT
-HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY
-OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
-THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
-PURPOSE.  THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM
-IS WITH YOU.  SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF
-ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
-
-  16. Limitation of Liability.
-
-  IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
-WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS
-THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY
-GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE
-USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
-DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD
-PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS),
-EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
-SUCH DAMAGES.
-
-  17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16.
-
-  If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided
-above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms,
-reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates
-an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the
-Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a
-copy of the Program in return for a fee.
-
-                     END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
-
-            How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
+Each version is given a distinguishing version number.  If the Program
+specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any
+later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions
+either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
+Software Foundation.  If the Program does not specify a version number of
+this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
+Foundation.
+
+  10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free
+programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author
+to ask for permission.  For software which is copyrighted by the Free
+Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes
+make exceptions for this.  Our decision will be guided by the two goals
+of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and
+of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
+
+			    NO WARRANTY
+
+  11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY
+FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW.  EXCEPT WHEN
+OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
+PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
+OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
+MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  THE ENTIRE RISK AS
+TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU.  SHOULD THE
+PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
+REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
+
+  12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
+WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
+REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
+INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING
+OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED
+TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY
+YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER
+PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
+POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
+
+		     END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
+
+	    How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
 
   If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
 possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
@@ -628,15 +287,15 @@
 
   To do so, attach the following notices to the program.  It is safest
 to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
-state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
+convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
 the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
 
     <one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.>
     Copyright (C) <year>  <name of author>
 
-    This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
+    This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
     it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
-    the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
+    the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
     (at your option) any later version.
 
     This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
@@ -645,30 +304,37 @@
     GNU General Public License for more details.
 
     You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-    along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
+    along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+    Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA  02111-1307  USA
+
 
 Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
 
-  If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short
-notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode:
+If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this
+when it starts in an interactive mode:
 
-    <program>  Copyright (C) <year>  <name of author>
-    This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'.
+    Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year  name of author
+    Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'.
     This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it
     under certain conditions; type `show c' for details.
 
 The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate
-parts of the General Public License.  Of course, your program's commands
-might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box".
-
-  You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school,
-if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary.
-For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see
-<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
-
-  The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program
-into proprietary programs.  If your program is a subroutine library, you
-may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with
-the library.  If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General
-Public License instead of this License.  But first, please read
-<http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>.
+parts of the General Public License.  Of course, the commands you use may
+be called something other than `show w' and `show c'; they could even be
+mouse-clicks or menu items--whatever suits your program.
+
+You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your
+school, if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if
+necessary.  Here is a sample; alter the names:
+
+  Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program
+  `Gnomovision' (which makes passes at compilers) written by James Hacker.
+
+  <signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989
+  Ty Coon, President of Vice
+
+This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
+proprietary programs.  If your program is a subroutine library, you may
+consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the
+library.  If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Library General
+Public License instead of this License.

Modified: branches/gcomprixogoo/INSTALL
==============================================================================
--- branches/gcomprixogoo/INSTALL	(original)
+++ branches/gcomprixogoo/INSTALL	Mon Oct 27 21:00:29 2008
@@ -1,19 +1,13 @@
-Installation Instructions
-*************************
+Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software
+Foundation, Inc.
 
-Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2004, 2005,
-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-
-This file is free documentation; the Free Software Foundation gives
+   This file is free documentation; the Free Software Foundation gives
 unlimited permission to copy, distribute and modify it.
 
 Basic Installation
 ==================
 
-Briefly, the shell commands `./configure; make; make install' should
-configure, build, and install this package.  The following
-more-detailed instructions are generic; see the `README' file for
-instructions specific to this package.
+   These are generic installation instructions.
 
    The `configure' shell script attempts to guess correct values for
 various system-dependent variables used during compilation.  It uses
@@ -26,9 +20,9 @@
 
    It can also use an optional file (typically called `config.cache'
 and enabled with `--cache-file=config.cache' or simply `-C') that saves
-the results of its tests to speed up reconfiguring.  Caching is
+the results of its tests to speed up reconfiguring.  (Caching is
 disabled by default to prevent problems with accidental use of stale
-cache files.
+cache files.)
 
    If you need to do unusual things to compile the package, please try
 to figure out how `configure' could check whether to do them, and mail
@@ -38,17 +32,20 @@
 may remove or edit it.
 
    The file `configure.ac' (or `configure.in') is used to create
-`configure' by a program called `autoconf'.  You need `configure.ac' if
-you want to change it or regenerate `configure' using a newer version
-of `autoconf'.
+`configure' by a program called `autoconf'.  You only need
+`configure.ac' if you want to change it or regenerate `configure' using
+a newer version of `autoconf'.
 
 The simplest way to compile this package is:
 
   1. `cd' to the directory containing the package's source code and type
-     `./configure' to configure the package for your system.
+     `./configure' to configure the package for your system.  If you're
+     using `csh' on an old version of System V, you might need to type
+     `sh ./configure' instead to prevent `csh' from trying to execute
+     `configure' itself.
 
-     Running `configure' might take a while.  While running, it prints
-     some messages telling which features it is checking for.
+     Running `configure' takes awhile.  While running, it prints some
+     messages telling which features it is checking for.
 
   2. Type `make' to compile the package.
 
@@ -70,49 +67,51 @@
 Compilers and Options
 =====================
 
-Some systems require unusual options for compilation or linking that the
-`configure' script does not know about.  Run `./configure --help' for
-details on some of the pertinent environment variables.
+   Some systems require unusual options for compilation or linking that
+the `configure' script does not know about.  Run `./configure --help'
+for details on some of the pertinent environment variables.
 
    You can give `configure' initial values for configuration parameters
 by setting variables in the command line or in the environment.  Here
 is an example:
 
-     ./configure CC=c99 CFLAGS=-g LIBS=-lposix
+     ./configure CC=c89 CFLAGS=-O2 LIBS=-lposix
 
    *Note Defining Variables::, for more details.
 
 Compiling For Multiple Architectures
 ====================================
 
-You can compile the package for more than one kind of computer at the
+   You can compile the package for more than one kind of computer at the
 same time, by placing the object files for each architecture in their
-own directory.  To do this, you can use GNU `make'.  `cd' to the
+own directory.  To do this, you must use a version of `make' that
+supports the `VPATH' variable, such as GNU `make'.  `cd' to the
 directory where you want the object files and executables to go and run
 the `configure' script.  `configure' automatically checks for the
 source code in the directory that `configure' is in and in `..'.
 
-   With a non-GNU `make', it is safer to compile the package for one
-architecture at a time in the source code directory.  After you have
-installed the package for one architecture, use `make distclean' before
-reconfiguring for another architecture.
+   If you have to use a `make' that does not support the `VPATH'
+variable, you have to compile the package for one architecture at a
+time in the source code directory.  After you have installed the
+package for one architecture, use `make distclean' before reconfiguring
+for another architecture.
 
 Installation Names
 ==================
 
-By default, `make install' installs the package's commands under
-`/usr/local/bin', include files under `/usr/local/include', etc.  You
-can specify an installation prefix other than `/usr/local' by giving
-`configure' the option `--prefix=PREFIX'.
+   By default, `make install' will install the package's files in
+`/usr/local/bin', `/usr/local/man', etc.  You can specify an
+installation prefix other than `/usr/local' by giving `configure' the
+option `--prefix=PATH'.
 
    You can specify separate installation prefixes for
 architecture-specific files and architecture-independent files.  If you
-pass the option `--exec-prefix=PREFIX' to `configure', the package uses
-PREFIX as the prefix for installing programs and libraries.
-Documentation and other data files still use the regular prefix.
+give `configure' the option `--exec-prefix=PATH', the package will use
+PATH as the prefix for installing programs and libraries.
+Documentation and other data files will still use the regular prefix.
 
    In addition, if you use an unusual directory layout you can give
-options like `--bindir=DIR' to specify different values for particular
+options like `--bindir=PATH' to specify different values for particular
 kinds of files.  Run `configure --help' for a list of the directories
 you can set and what kinds of files go in them.
 
@@ -123,7 +122,7 @@
 Optional Features
 =================
 
-Some packages pay attention to `--enable-FEATURE' options to
+   Some packages pay attention to `--enable-FEATURE' options to
 `configure', where FEATURE indicates an optional part of the package.
 They may also pay attention to `--with-PACKAGE' options, where PACKAGE
 is something like `gnu-as' or `x' (for the X Window System).  The
@@ -138,11 +137,11 @@
 Specifying the System Type
 ==========================
 
-There may be some features `configure' cannot figure out automatically,
-but needs to determine by the type of machine the package will run on.
-Usually, assuming the package is built to be run on the _same_
-architectures, `configure' can figure that out, but if it prints a
-message saying it cannot guess the machine type, give it the
+   There may be some features `configure' cannot figure out
+automatically, but needs to determine by the type of machine the package
+will run on.  Usually, assuming the package is built to be run on the
+_same_ architectures, `configure' can figure that out, but if it prints
+a message saying it cannot guess the machine type, give it the
 `--build=TYPE' option.  TYPE can either be a short name for the system
 type, such as `sun4', or a canonical name which has the form:
 
@@ -157,7 +156,7 @@
 need to know the machine type.
 
    If you are _building_ compiler tools for cross-compiling, you should
-use the option `--target=TYPE' to select the type of system they will
+use the `--target=TYPE' option to select the type of system they will
 produce code for.
 
    If you want to _use_ a cross compiler, that generates code for a
@@ -168,9 +167,9 @@
 Sharing Defaults
 ================
 
-If you want to set default values for `configure' scripts to share, you
-can create a site shell script called `config.site' that gives default
-values for variables like `CC', `cache_file', and `prefix'.
+   If you want to set default values for `configure' scripts to share,
+you can create a site shell script called `config.site' that gives
+default values for variables like `CC', `cache_file', and `prefix'.
 `configure' looks for `PREFIX/share/config.site' if it exists, then
 `PREFIX/etc/config.site' if it exists.  Or, you can set the
 `CONFIG_SITE' environment variable to the location of the site script.
@@ -179,7 +178,7 @@
 Defining Variables
 ==================
 
-Variables not defined in a site shell script can be set in the
+   Variables not defined in a site shell script can be set in the
 environment passed to `configure'.  However, some packages may run
 configure again during the build, and the customized values of these
 variables may be lost.  In order to avoid this problem, you should set
@@ -187,18 +186,14 @@
 
      ./configure CC=/usr/local2/bin/gcc
 
-causes the specified `gcc' to be used as the C compiler (unless it is
+will cause the specified gcc to be used as the C compiler (unless it is
 overridden in the site shell script).
 
-Unfortunately, this technique does not work for `CONFIG_SHELL' due to
-an Autoconf bug.  Until the bug is fixed you can use this workaround:
-
-     CONFIG_SHELL=/bin/bash /bin/bash ./configure CONFIG_SHELL=/bin/bash
-
 `configure' Invocation
 ======================
 
-`configure' recognizes the following options to control how it operates.
+   `configure' recognizes the following options to control how it
+operates.
 
 `--help'
 `-h'

Modified: branches/gcomprixogoo/docs/C/texinfo.tex
==============================================================================
--- branches/gcomprixogoo/docs/C/texinfo.tex	(original)
+++ branches/gcomprixogoo/docs/C/texinfo.tex	Mon Oct 27 21:00:29 2008
@@ -3,16 +3,15 @@
 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
 %
-\def\texinfoversion{2007-12-02.17}
+\def\texinfoversion{2003-10-06.08}
 %
-% Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 2007,
-% 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
-% 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+% Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
+% 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
 %
-% This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
+% This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
-% published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
-% License, or (at your option) any later version.
+% published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at
+% your option) any later version.
 %
 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
@@ -20,18 +19,25 @@
 % General Public License for more details.
 %
 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
-% along with this program.  If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
-%
-% As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
-% a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
-% restriction.  (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
+% along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING.  If not, write
+% to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
+% Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
+%
+% In other words, you are welcome to use, share and improve this program.
+% You are forbidden to forbid anyone else to use, share and improve
+% what you give them.   Help stamp out software-hoarding!
 %
 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
-%   http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
+%   ftp://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/texinfo.tex
+%     (and all GNU mirrors, see http://www.gnu.org/order/ftp.html)
 %   ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
-%     (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
-% The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
+%     (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org),
+%   and /home/gd/gnu/doc/texinfo.tex on the GNU machines.
+%
+% The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
+%
+% The texinfo.tex in any given Texinfo distribution could well be out
 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
 %
 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo gnu org   Please include including a
@@ -53,9 +59,6 @@
 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
 % extent.  You can get the existing language-specific files from the
 % full Texinfo distribution.
-%
-% The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
-
 
 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
 
@@ -65,7 +68,7 @@
 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
   \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
 
-
+\message{Basics,}
 \chardef\other=12
 
 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
@@ -82,16 +85,13 @@
 \let\ptexend=\end
 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv
 \let\ptexexclam=\!
-\let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
 \let\ptexgtr=>
 \let\ptexhat=^
 \let\ptexi=\i
 \let\ptexindent=\indent
-\let\ptexinsert=\insert
+\let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
 \let\ptexlbrace=\{
 \let\ptexless=<
-\let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
-\let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
 \let\ptexplus=+
 \let\ptexrbrace=\}
 \let\ptexslash=\/
@@ -102,15 +102,6 @@
 % starts a new line in the output.
 \newlinechar = `^^J
 
-% Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
-% messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
-%
-\ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
-  \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
-\else
-  \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
-\fi
-
 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined  \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined   \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
@@ -149,83 +140,43 @@
 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined   \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined    \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined    \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
+\ifx\putwordDeftypevar\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypevar{Variable}\fi
 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined   \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
+\ifx\putwordDeftypefun\undefined\gdef\putwordDeftypefun{Function}\fi
 
-% Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
-\chardef\spacecat = 10
-\def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat}
-
-% sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
+% In some macros, we cannot use the `\? notation---the left quote is
+% in some cases the escape char.
 \chardef\colonChar = `\:
 \chardef\commaChar = `\,
-\chardef\dashChar  = `\-
 \chardef\dotChar   = `\.
+\chardef\equalChar = `\=
 \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
-\chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
 \chardef\questChar = `\?
-\chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
 \chardef\semiChar  = `\;
+\chardef\spaceChar = `\ %
 \chardef\underChar = `\_
 
 % Ignore a token.
 %
 \def\gobble#1{}
 
-% The following is used inside several \edef's.
-\def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
+% True if #1 is the empty string, i.e., called like `\ifempty{}'.
+%
+\def\ifempty#1{\ifemptyx #1\emptymarkA\emptymarkB}%
+\def\ifemptyx#1#2\emptymarkB{\ifx #1\emptymarkA}%
 
 % Hyphenation fixes.
-\hyphenation{
-  Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
-  ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
-  data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
-  man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
-  par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
-  spell-ing spell-ings
-  stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
-  wide-spread wrap-around
-}
+\hyphenation{ap-pen-dix}
+\hyphenation{eshell}
+\hyphenation{mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers}
+\hyphenation{time-stamp}
+\hyphenation{white-space}
 
 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
 \newdimen\bindingoffset
 \newdimen\normaloffset
 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
 
-% For a final copy, take out the rectangles
-% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
-% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
-%
-\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
-
-% @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line.  It should
-% surround any changed text.  This approach does *not* work if the
-% change spans more than two lines of output.  To handle that, we would
-% have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
-% vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
-%
-\def\|{%
-  % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
-  \leavevmode
-  %
-  % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
-  \vadjust{%
-    % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
-    % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
-    \vskip-\baselineskip
-    %
-    % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type.  So
-    % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
-    \llap{%
-      %
-      % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
-      \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
-      %
-      % This is the space between the bar and the text.
-      \hskip 12pt
-    }%
-  }%
-}
-
 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
 % and nothing on the terminal.  We don't just call \tracingall here,
 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal.  We also make
@@ -250,7 +201,7 @@
     \tracingassigns1
   \fi
   \tracingcommands3  % 3 gives us more in etex
-  \errorcontextlines16
+  \errorcontextlines\maxdimen
 }%
 
 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions.  If the last thing
@@ -277,50 +228,6 @@
 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
 
-% Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
-% We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
-% This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
-%
-% A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
-% \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
-%
-% Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
-% (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
-% of a page, or that at the bottom of a page.  The solution is
-% described on page 260 of The TeXbook.  It involves outputting two
-% marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and
-% one after.  I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK...
-\def\domark{%
-  \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
-  \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
-  \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
-  \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
-  \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
-  \mark{%
-                   \the\toks0 \the\toks2
-      \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6
-    \noexpand\else \the\toks8
-  }%
-}
-% \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
-% page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
-% the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
-% @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
-% first @chapter.
-\def\gettopheadingmarks{%
-  \ifcase0\topmark\fi
-  \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
-}
-\def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
-\def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
-
-% Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
-\def\lastchapterdefs{}
-\def\lastsectiondefs{}
-\def\prevchapterdefs{}
-\def\prevsectiondefs{}
-\def\lastcolordefs{}
-
 % Main output routine.
 \chardef\PAGE = 255
 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
@@ -338,9 +245,7 @@
   %
   % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
   % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
-  \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
   \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
-  \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
   \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}%
   %
   {%
@@ -348,17 +253,13 @@
     % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
     % before the \shipout runs.
     %
+    \escapechar = `\\     % use backslash in output files.
     \indexdummies         % don't expand commands in the output.
     \normalturnoffactive  % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
-               % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
-               % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
-               % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
-               % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
-               % it needs to be 
-               % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
+                   % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
     \shipout\vbox{%
       % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
-      \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
+      \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfmkdest{\the\pageno}\fi
       %
       \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
         \hsize = \outerhsize
@@ -383,9 +284,9 @@
       \pagebody{#1}%
       \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
         % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
-        % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
+        % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingxxx.)
         % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
-        \vskip 24pt
+        \vskip 2\baselineskip
         \unvbox\footlinebox
       \fi
       %
@@ -406,7 +307,7 @@
       \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
       \fi
     }% end of \shipout\vbox
-  }% end of group with \indexdummies
+  }% end of group with \normalturnoffactive
   \advancepageno
   \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
 }
@@ -419,7 +320,7 @@
 % marginal hacks, juha viisa uucp (Juha Takala)
 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
   \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z {\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
-\dimen =\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
+\dimen =\dp#1 \unvbox#1
 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
 \ifr ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
 }
@@ -439,161 +340,132 @@
 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment).  #1 should be a
 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
 %
-\def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
-\def\parseargusing#1#2{%
-  \def\argtorun{#2}%
+\def\parsearg#1{%
+  \let\next = #1%
   \begingroup
     \obeylines
-    \spaceisspace
-    #1%
-    \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
+    \futurelet\temp\parseargx
+}
+
+% If the next token is an obeyed space (from an @example environment or
+% the like), remove it and recurse.  Otherwise, we're done.
+\def\parseargx{%
+  % \obeyedspace is defined far below, after the definition of \sepspaces.
+  \ifx\obeyedspace\temp
+    \expandafter\parseargdiscardspace
+  \else
+    \expandafter\parseargline
+  \fi
 }
 
+% Remove a single space (as the delimiter token to the macro call).
+{\obeyspaces %
+ \gdef\parseargdiscardspace {\futurelet\temp\parseargx}}
+
 {\obeylines %
   \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
     \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
-    \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
+    %
+    % First remove any @c comment, then any @comment.
+    % Result of each macro is put in \toks0.
+    \argremovec #1\c\relax %
+    \expandafter\argremovecomment \the\toks0 \comment\relax %
+    %
+    % Call the caller's macro, saved as \next in \parsearg.
+    \expandafter\next\expandafter{\the\toks0}%
   }%
 }
 
-% First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
-\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
-\def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
+% Since all \c{,omment} does is throw away the argument, we can let TeX
+% do that for us.  The \relax here is matched by the \relax in the call
+% in \parseargline; it could be more or less anything, its purpose is
+% just to delimit the argument to the \c.
+\def\argremovec#1\c#2\relax{\toks0 = {#1}}
+\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\relax{\toks0 = {#1}}
 
-% Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
-%
-% \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
+% \argremovec{,omment} might leave us with trailing spaces, though; e.g.,
 %    @end itemize  @c foo
-% This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
-% by \finishparsearg.
+% will have two active spaces as part of the argument with the
+% `itemize'.  Here we remove all active spaces from #1, and assign the
+% result to \toks0.
+%
+% This loses if there are any *other* active characters besides spaces
+% in the argument -- _ ^ +, for example -- since they get expanded.
+% Fortunately, Texinfo does not define any such commands.  (If it ever
+% does, the catcode of the characters in questionwill have to be changed
+% here.)  But this means we cannot call \removeactivespaces as part of
+% \argremovec{,omment}, since @c uses \parsearg, and thus the argument
+% that \parsearg gets might well have any character at all in it.
 %
-\def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
-\def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
-\def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
-  \def\temp{#3}%
-  \ifx\temp\empty
-    % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
-    \let\temp\finishparsearg
-  \else
-    \let\temp\argcheckspaces
-  \fi
-  % Put the space token in:
-  \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
+\def\removeactivespaces#1{%
+  \begingroup
+    \ignoreactivespaces
+    \edef\temp{#1}%
+    \global\toks0 = \expandafter{\temp}%
+  \endgroup
 }
 
-% If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
-% to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
-% We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
-% just before passing the control to \argtorun.
-% (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
-% either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
-% that a pair of braces would be stripped.
-%
-% But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
+% Change the active space to expand to nothing.
 %
-\def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
+\begingroup
+  \obeyspaces
+  \gdef\ignoreactivespaces{\obeyspaces\let =\empty}
+\endgroup
 
-% \parseargdef\foo{...}
-%	is roughly equivalent to
-% \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
-% \def\Xfoo#1{...}
-%
-% Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
-% favourite TeX trick.  --kasal, 16nov03
 
-\def\parseargdef#1{%
-  \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
-}
-\def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
-  \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
-  \def#1##1%
-}
+\def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
 
-% Several utility definitions with active space:
-{
-  \obeyspaces
-  \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
+%% These are used to keep @begin/@end levels from running away
+%% Call \inENV within environments (after a \begingroup)
+\newif\ifENV \ENVfalse \def\inENV{\ifENV\relax\else\ENVtrue\fi}
+\def\ENVcheck{%
+\ifENV\errmessage{Still within an environment; press RETURN to continue}
+\endgroup\fi} % This is not perfect, but it should reduce lossage
 
-  % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
-  % space in the output.  Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
-  % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
-  % should produce a line of output anyway.
-  %
-  \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
-
-  % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
-  % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
-  % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \ M \ ).
-  \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
-}
+% @begin foo  is the same as @foo, for now.
+\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
 
+\outer\def\begin{\parsearg\beginxxx}
 
-\def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
+\def\beginxxx #1{%
+\expandafter\ifx\csname #1\endcsname\relax
+{\errhelp=\EMsimple \errmessage{Undefined command @begin #1}}\else
+\csname #1\endcsname\fi}
 
-% Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex.  It's used like this:
-%
-%   \envdef\foo{...}
-%   \def\Efoo{...}
+% @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
 %
-% It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
-% actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo.  \envdef also
-% defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
-% whether the environment name matches.  The \checkenv macro can also be
-% used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
-%
-% Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
-% are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group.  (The
-% implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
-% special case.)
-
-
-% At runtime, environments start with this:
-\def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
-% initialize
-\let\thisenv\empty
-
-% ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
-\long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
-\def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
-
-% Check whether we're in the right environment:
-\def\checkenv#1{%
-  \def\temp{#1}%
-  \ifx\thisenv\temp
+\def\end{\parsearg\endxxx}
+\def\endxxx #1{%
+  \removeactivespaces{#1}%
+  \edef\endthing{\the\toks0}%
+  %
+  \expandafter\ifx\csname E\endthing\endcsname\relax
+    \expandafter\ifx\csname \endthing\endcsname\relax
+      % There's no \foo, i.e., no ``environment'' foo.
+      \errhelp = \EMsimple
+      \errmessage{Undefined command ` end \endthing'}%
+    \else
+      \unmatchedenderror\endthing
+    \fi
   \else
-    \badenverr
+    % Everything's ok; the right environment has been started.
+    \csname E\endthing\endcsname
   \fi
 }
 
-% Evironment mismatch, #1 expected:
-\def\badenverr{%
+% There is an environment #1, but it hasn't been started.  Give an error.
+%
+\def\unmatchedenderror#1{%
   \errhelp = \EMsimple
-  \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
-    not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
-}
-\def\inenvironment#1{%
-  \ifx#1\empty
-    out of any environment%
-  \else
-    in environment \expandafter\string#1%
-  \fi
+  \errmessage{This ` end #1' doesn't have a matching ` #1'}%
 }
 
-% @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
-% But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
+% Define the control sequence \E#1 to give an unmatched @end error.
 %
-\parseargdef\end{%
-  \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
-  \else
-    % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
-    \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
-    \csname E#1\endcsname
-    \endgroup
-  \fi
+\def\defineunmatchedend#1{%
+  \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\unmatchedenderror{#1}}%
 }
 
-\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
-
 
 %% Simple single-character @ commands
 
@@ -615,7 +487,7 @@
 \let\}=\myrbrace
 \begingroup
   % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
-  % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
+  % and @{ and @} for the aux file.
   \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
   \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
   \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
@@ -625,9 +497,6 @@
   !gdef!rbraceatcmd[ }]%
 !endgroup
 
-% @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
-\let\comma = ,
-
 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
 \let\, = \c
@@ -637,12 +506,10 @@
 \let\ubaraccent = \b
 \let\udotaccent = \d
 
-% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
+% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown
 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
 \def\questiondown{?`}
 \def\exclamdown{!`}
-\def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
-\def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
 
 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
 \def\imacro{i}
@@ -655,25 +522,6 @@
   \fi\fi
 }
 
-% The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
-% period following counts as ending a sentence.  (Idea found in latex.)
-%
-\edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
-
-% @LaTeX{} logo.  Not quite the same results as the definition in
-% latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
-% convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
-% the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
-% \scriptscriptstyle).
-%
-\def\LaTeX{%
-  L\kern-.36em
-  {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
-   \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}%
-  \kern-.15em
-  \TeX
-}
-
 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
@@ -696,28 +544,13 @@
 \let\/=\allowbreak
 
 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
-\def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
+\def\.{.\spacefactor=3000 }
 
 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
-\def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
+\def\!{!\spacefactor=3000 }
 
 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
-\def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
-
-% @frenchspacing on|off  says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
-% 
-\def\onword{on}
-\def\offword{off}
-%
-\parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
-  \def\temp{#1}%
-  \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
-  \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
-  \else
-    \errhelp = \EMsimple
-    \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on/off}%
-  \fi\fi
-}
+\def\?{?\spacefactor=3000 }
 
 % @w prevents a word break.  Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
@@ -742,14 +575,59 @@
 \newbox\groupbox
 \def\vfilllimit{0.7}
 %
-\envdef\group{%
-  \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
+\def\group{\begingroup
+  \ifnum\catcode13=\active \else
     \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
     \errmessage{ group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
   \fi
-  \startsavinginserts
+  %
+  % The \vtop we start below produces a box with normal height and large
+  % depth; thus, TeX puts \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the
+  % next line of text is done) \lineskip glue after it.  (See p.82 of
+  % the TeXbook.)  Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
+  % above.  But it's pretty close.
+  \def\Egroup{%
+    \egroup           % End the \vtop.
+    % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
+    \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox  \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
+    % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
+    \dimen2 = \pageheight   \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
+    % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
+    % group, force a page break.
+    \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
+      \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
+        \page
+      \fi
+    \fi
+    \copy\groupbox
+    \endgroup         % End the \group.
+  }%
   %
   \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
+    % We have to put a strut on the last line in case the @group is in
+    % the midst of an example, rather than completely enclosing it.
+    % Otherwise, the interline space between the last line of the group
+    % and the first line afterwards is too small.  But we can't put the
+    % strut in \Egroup, since there it would be on a line by itself.
+    % Hence this just inserts a strut at the beginning of each line.
+    \everypar = {\strut}%
+    %
+    % Since we have a strut on every line, we don't need any of TeX's
+    % normal interline spacing.
+    \offinterlineskip
+    %
+    % OK, but now we have to do something about blank
+    % lines in the input in @example-like environments, which normally
+    % just turn into \lisppar, which will insert no space now that we've
+    % turned off the interline space.  Simplest is to make them be an
+    % empty paragraph.
+    \ifx\par\lisppar
+      \edef\par{\leavevmode \par}%
+      %
+      % Reset ^^M's definition to new definition of \par.
+      \obeylines
+    \fi
+    %
     % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
     % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
     % end-of-line in the output.  We don't want the end-of-line after
@@ -759,32 +637,6 @@
     \comment
 }
 %
-% The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
-% \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
-% \lineskip glue after it.  Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
-% above.  But it's pretty close.
-\def\Egroup{%
-    % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
-    % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
-    \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
-    \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
-  \egroup           % End the \vtop.
-  % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
-  \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox  \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
-  % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
-  \dimen2 = \pageheight   \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
-  % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
-  % group, force a page break.
-  \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
-    \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
-      \page
-    \fi
-  \fi
-  \box\groupbox
-  \prevdepth = \dimen1
-  \checkinserts
-}
-%
 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
 % message, so this ends up printing ` group can only ...'.
 %
@@ -797,8 +649,10 @@
 
 \newdimen\mil  \mil=0.001in
 
+\def\need{\parsearg\needx}
+
 % Old definition--didn't work.
-%\parseargdef\need{\par %
+%\def\needx #1{\par %
 %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
 %% if the depth of the box does not fit.
 %{\baselineskip=0pt%
@@ -806,7 +660,7 @@
 %\prevdepth=-1000pt
 %}}
 
-\parseargdef\need{%
+\def\needx#1{%
   % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
   % paragraph.
   \par
@@ -845,10 +699,35 @@
   \fi
 }
 
-% @br   forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
+% @br   forces paragraph break
 
 \let\br = \par
 
+% @dots{} output an ellipsis using the current font.
+% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter
+% font as three actual period characters.
+%
+\def\dots{%
+  \leavevmode
+  \hbox to 1.5em{%
+    \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil
+    .\hss.\hss.%
+    \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil
+  }%
+}
+
+% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
+%
+\def\enddots{%
+  \leavevmode
+  \hbox to 2em{%
+    \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil minus 0.25fil
+    .\hss.\hss.\hss.%
+    \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil minus 0.5fil
+  }%
+  \spacefactor=3000
+}
+
 % @page forces the start of a new page.
 %
 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
@@ -861,11 +740,13 @@
 \newskip\exdentamount
 
 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
-\parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
+\def\exdent{\parsearg\exdentyyy}
+\def\exdentyyy #1{{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}}
 
 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
-\parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
-  \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
+\def\nofillexdent{\parsearg\nofillexdentyyy}
+\def\nofillexdentyyy #1{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
+\leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
 
 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
 % paragraph.  For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
@@ -917,19 +798,8 @@
 }
 
 % @include file    insert text of that file as input.
-%
-\def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
-\def\includezzz#1{%
-  \pushthisfilestack
-  \def\thisfile{#1}%
-  {%
-    \makevalueexpandable
-    \def\temp{\input #1 }%
-    \expandafter
-  }\temp
-  \popthisfilestack
-}
-\def\filenamecatcodes{%
+% Allow normal characters that  we make active in the argument (a file name).
+\def\include{\begingroup
   \catcode`\\=\other
   \catcode`~=\other
   \catcode`^=\other
@@ -938,50 +808,33 @@
   \catcode`<=\other
   \catcode`>=\other
   \catcode`+=\other
-  \catcode`-=\other
-}
-
-\def\pushthisfilestack{%
-  \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
-}
-\def\pushthisfilestackX{%
-  \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
-}
-\def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
-  \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
-}
-
-\def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
-\def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
-  the stack of filenames is empty.}}
+  \parsearg\includezzz}
+% Restore active chars for included file.
+\def\includezzz#1{\endgroup\begingroup
+  % Read the included file in a group so nested @include's work.
+  \def\thisfile{#1}%
+  \let\value=\expandablevalue
+  \input\thisfile
+\endgroup}
 
 \def\thisfile{}
 
 % @center line
 % outputs that line, centered.
 %
-\parseargdef\center{%
-  \ifhmode
-    \let\next\centerH
-  \else
-    \let\next\centerV
-  \fi
-  \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
-}
-\def\centerH#1{%
-  {%
-    \hfil\break
-    \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
-    \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
-    \line{#1}%
-    \break
-  }%
-}
-\def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
+\def\center{\parsearg\docenter}
+\def\docenter#1{{%
+  \ifhmode \hfil\break \fi
+  \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
+  \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
+  \line{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
+  \ifhmode \break \fi
+}}
 
 % @sp n   outputs n lines of vertical space
 
-\parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
+\def\sp{\parsearg\spxxx}
+\def\spxxx #1{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
 
 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
 % @c is the same as @comment
@@ -1002,7 +855,8 @@
 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
 \def\noneword{none}
 %
-\parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
+\def\paragraphindent{\parsearg\doparagraphindent}
+\def\doparagraphindent#1{%
   \def\temp{#1}%
   \ifx\temp\asisword
   \else
@@ -1019,7 +873,8 @@
 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
-\parseargdef\exampleindent{%
+\def\exampleindent{\parsearg\doexampleindent}
+\def\doexampleindent#1{%
   \def\temp{#1}%
   \ifx\temp\asisword
   \else
@@ -1042,9 +897,12 @@
 % By default, we suppress indentation.
 %
 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
+\newdimen\currentparindent
+%
 \def\insertword{insert}
 %
-\parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
+\def\firstparagraphindent{\parsearg\dofirstparagraphindent}
+\def\dofirstparagraphindent#1{%
   \def\temp{#1}%
   \ifx\temp\noneword
     \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
@@ -1089,18 +947,23 @@
 \def\asis#1{#1}
 
 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
+% We don't use $'s directly in the definition of \math because we need
+% to set catcodes according to plain TeX first, to allow for subscripts,
+% superscripts, special math chars, etc.
+%
+\let\implicitmath = $%$ font-lock fix
 %
 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
 % an actual _ character, as in @math{ var{some_variable} + 1}.  So make
-% _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
-% which is what @var uses.
-{
-  \catcode`\_ = \active
-  \gdef\mathunderscore{%
-    \catcode`\_=\active
-    \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
-  }
-}
+% _ within @math be active (mathcode "8000), and distinguish by seeing
+% if the current family is \slfam, which is what @var uses.
+%
+{\catcode\underChar = \active
+\gdef\mathunderscore{%
+  \catcode\underChar=\active
+  \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
+}}
+%
 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
 % this is not advertised and we don't care.  Texinfo does not
@@ -1111,16 +974,15 @@
 %
 \def\math{%
   \tex
-  \mathunderscore
+  \mathcode`\_="8000 \mathunderscore
   \let\\ = \mathbackslash
   \mathactive
-  $\finishmath
-}
-\def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup}  % Close the group opened by \tex.
+  \implicitmath\finishmath}
+\def\finishmath#1{#1\implicitmath\Etex}
 
 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
-% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
-% to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
+% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an
+% argument to a command which set the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
 %
 {
   \catcode`^ = \active
@@ -1136,42 +998,8 @@
 }
 
 % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above.
-\def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$}
-\def\minus{$-$}
-
-% @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
-% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
-% typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
-% in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em.  So do
-% whichever is larger.
-%
-\def\dots{%
-  \leavevmode
-  \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
-  \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
-    \dimen0 = \wd0
-  \else
-    \dimen0 = 1.5em
-  \fi
-  \hbox to \dimen0{%
-    \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
-    .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
-    .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
-    .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
-  }%
-}
-
-% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
-%
-\def\enddots{%
-  \dots
-  \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
-}
-
-% @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
-% Texinfo's parsing.
-%
-\let\comma = ,
+\def\bullet{\implicitmath\ptexbullet\implicitmath}
+\def\minus{\implicitmath-\implicitmath}
 
 % @refill is a no-op.
 \let\refill=\relax
@@ -1187,20 +1015,20 @@
 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
 \def\setfilename{%
-   \fixbackslash  % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
    \iflinks
-     \tryauxfile
-     % Open the new aux file.  TeX will close it automatically at exit.
-     \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
+     \readauxfile
    \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
    \openindices
-   \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
+   \fixbackslash  % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
+   \global\let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
    %
    % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
    % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
+   % Just to be on the safe side, close the input stream before the \input.
    \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
-   \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
-   \closein 1
+   \ifeof1 \let\temp=\relax \else \def\temp{\input texinfo.cnf }\fi
+   \closein1
+   \temp
    %
    \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
 }
@@ -1236,147 +1064,21 @@
 \newif\ifpdf
 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
 
-% when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
-% can be set).  So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
-% borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
+  \pdffalse
+  \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
+  \let\pdfurl = \gobble
+  \let\endlink = \relax
+  \let\linkcolor = \relax
+  \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
 \else
-  \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
-  \else
-    \ifcase\pdfoutput
-    \else
-      \pdftrue
-    \fi
-  \fi
-\fi
-
-% PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
-% for display in the outlines, and in other places.  Thus, we have to
-% double any backslashes.  Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
-% interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e.  Not good.
-% http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html
-% (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX
-% user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
-% that's what we do).
-
-% double active backslashes.
-% 
-{\catcode`\ =0 \catcode`\\=\active
- @gdef activebackslashdouble{%
-   @catcode` \=@active
-   @let\= doublebackslash}
-}
-
-% To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are
-% not active characters.  hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as
-% us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens, with minor
-% changes for Texinfo.  It is included here under the GPL by permission
-% from the author, Heiko Oberdiek.
-% 
-% #1 is the tokens to replace.
-% #2 is the replacement.
-% #3 is the control sequence with the string.
-% 
-\def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{%
-  \def\HyPsdReplace##1#1##2\END{%
-    ##1%
-    \ifx\\##2\\%
-    \else
-      #2%
-      \HyReturnAfterFi{%
-        \HyPsdReplace##2\END
-      }%
-    \fi
-  }%
-  \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}%
-}
-\long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1}
-
-% #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements.
-\def\backslashparens#1{%
-  \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply
-             % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest.
-  \HyPsdSubst{(}{\realbackslash(}{#1}%
-  \HyPsdSubst{)}{\realbackslash)}{#1}%
-}
-
-\newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
-with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found.  (.eps cannot
-be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
-output) for that.)}
-
-\ifpdf
-  %
-  % Color manipulation macros based on pdfcolor.tex.
-  \def\cmykDarkRed{0.28 1 1 0.35}
-  \def\cmykBlack{0 0 0 1}
-  %
-  \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 k}}
-  % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
-  % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
-  \def\setcolor#1{%
-    \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
-    \domark
-    \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
-  }
-  %
-  \def\maincolor{\cmykBlack}
-  \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
-  \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
-  \def\lastcolordefs{}
-  %
-  \def\makefootline{%
-    \baselineskip24pt
-    \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
-  }
-  %
-  \def\makeheadline{%
-    \vbox to 0pt{%
-      \vskip-22.5pt
-      \line{%
-        \vbox to8.5pt{}%
-        % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
-        \getcolormarks
-        % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
-        \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
-      }%
-      \vss
-    }%
-    \nointerlineskip
-  }
-  %
-  %
-  \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
-  %
-  % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
+  \pdftrue
+  \pdfoutput = 1
+  \input pdfcolor
+  \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}%
   \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
-    \def\imagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
-    \def\imageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
-    %
-    % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .png, .jpg, .pdf (among
-    % others).  Let's try in that order.
-    \let\pdfimgext=\empty
-    \begingroup
-      \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
-        \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
-          \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
-            \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
-              \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
-                \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
-                \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
-              \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
-              \fi
-            \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
-            \fi
-          \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
-          \fi
-        \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
-        \fi
-      \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
-      \fi
-      \closein 1
-    \endgroup
-    %
+    \def\imagewidth{#2}%
+    \def\imageheight{#3}%
     % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is
     % included twice.  (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
     \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
@@ -1384,38 +1086,20 @@
     \else
       \immediate\pdfximage
     \fi
-      \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \imagewidth \fi
-      \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \imageheight \fi
+      \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi
+      \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi
       \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
-         #1.\pdfimgext
+         #1.pdf%
        \else
-         {#1.\pdfimgext}%
+         {#1.pdf}%
        \fi
     \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
       \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
     \fi}
-  %
-  \def\pdfmkdest#1{{%
-    % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
-    % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
-    \indexnofonts
-    \turnoffactive
-    \activebackslashdouble
-    \makevalueexpandable
-    \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
-    \backslashparens\pdfdestname
-    \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
-  }}
-  %
-  % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
+  \def\pdfmkdest#1{{\normalturnoffactive \pdfdest name{#1} xyz}}
   \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
-  %
-  % by default, use a color that is dark enough to print on paper as
-  % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing.
-  \def\urlcolor{\cmykDarkRed}
-  \def\linkcolor{\cmykDarkRed}
-  \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
-  %
+  \let\linkcolor = \Blue  % was Cyan, but that seems light?
+  \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink}
   % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
   % come from Petr Olsak
   \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
@@ -1424,60 +1108,39 @@
     \advance\tempnum by 1
     \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
   %
-  % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
-  % outline by the pdf viewer.  #2 is the pdf expression for the number
-  % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections).  #3 is the node text,
-  % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
-  % #4 is the page number
-  %
+  % #1 is the section text.  #2 is the pdf expression for the number
+  % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections).  #3 is the node
+  % text, which might be empty if this toc entry had no
+  % corresponding node.  #4 is the page number.
+  % 
   \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
     % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
     % page number.  We could generate a destination for the section
     % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
-    % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
+    % seem worthwhile, since most documents are normally structured.
     \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
-    \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
-      \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
-    \else
-      % Doubled backslashes in the name.
-      {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
-       \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}%
-    \fi
+    \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}\fi
     %
-    % Also double the backslashes in the display string.
-    {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
-     \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}%
-    %
-    \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
+    \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{#1}%
   }
   %
   \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
-    \begingroup
+    \openin 1 \jobname.toc
+    \ifeof 1\else\begingroup
+      \closein 1
       % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
       \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace
       \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace
       %
       % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
-      \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
-	\def\thischapnum{##2}%
-	\def\thissecnum{0}%
-	\def\thissubsecnum{0}%
-      }%
+      \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{\def\thischapnum{##2}}%
       \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
-	\advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
-	\def\thissecnum{##2}%
-	\def\thissubsecnum{0}%
-      }%
+        \def\thissecnum{##2}%
+        \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}}%
       \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
-	\advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
-	\def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
-      }%
-      \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
-	\advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
-      }%
-      \def\thischapnum{0}%
-      \def\thissecnum{0}%
-      \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
+        \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
+        \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}}%
+      \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{\advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}}%
       %
       % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
       % al. a second time, below.
@@ -1489,12 +1152,12 @@
       \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
       \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
       \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
-      \readdatafile{toc}%
+      \input \jobname.toc
       %
       % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
       % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
       % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
-      %
+      % 
       % We use the node names as the destinations.
       \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
         \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
@@ -1505,22 +1168,44 @@
       \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
         \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
       %
-      % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
-      % document fonts.  Therefore we cannot use special characters,
-      % since the encoding is unknown.  For example, the eogonek from
-      % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character.  Info from
-      % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
-      %
-      % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
-      % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding.  Right
-      % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
+      % Make special characters normal for writing to the pdf file.
       \indexnofonts
-      \setupdatafile
-      \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
-      \input \tocreadfilename
-    \endgroup
+      \turnoffactive
+      \input \jobname.toc
+    \endgroup\fi
   }
   %
+  \def\makelinks #1,{%
+    \def\params{#1}\def\E{END}%
+    \ifx\params\E
+      \let\nextmakelinks=\relax
+    \else
+      \let\nextmakelinks=\makelinks
+      \ifnum\lnkcount>0,\fi
+      \picknum{#1}%
+      \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}
+        goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\the\pgn}}%
+      \linkcolor #1%
+      \advance\lnkcount by 1%
+      \endlink
+    \fi
+    \nextmakelinks
+  }
+  \def\picknum#1{\expandafter\pn#1}
+  \def\pn#1{%
+    \def\p{#1}%
+    \ifx\p\lbrace
+      \let\nextpn=\ppn
+    \else
+      \let\nextpn=\ppnn
+      \def\first{#1}
+    \fi
+    \nextpn
+  }
+  \def\ppn#1{\pgn=#1\gobble}
+  \def\ppnn{\pgn=\first}
+  \def\pdfmklnk#1{\lnkcount=0\makelinks #1,END,}
+  \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
   \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
     \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
     \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
@@ -1535,28 +1220,21 @@
   \else
     \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
   \fi
-  % make a live url in pdf output.
   \def\pdfurl#1{%
     \begingroup
-      % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
-      % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
-      % of @url.  for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
-      % people have actually reported a problem with.
-      % 
-      \normalturnoffactive
-      \def\ {@}%
-      \let\/=\empty
-      \makevalueexpandable
-      \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
+      \normalturnoffactive\def\ {@}%
+      \let\value=\expandablevalue
+      \leavevmode\Red
       \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
         user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
+        % #1
     \endgroup}
   \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
   \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
   \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
   \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
   \def\maketoks{%
-    \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
+    \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|
     \ifx\first0\adn0
     \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
     \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
@@ -1574,48 +1252,22 @@
     {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
   \def\pdflink#1{%
     \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
-    \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
+    \linkcolor #1\endlink}
   \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
-\else
-  \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
-  \let\pdfurl = \gobble
-  \let\endlink = \relax
-  \let\setcolor = \gobble
-  \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
-  \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
-\fi  % \ifx\pdfoutput
+\fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
 
 
 \message{fonts,}
-
-% Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
-% For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{ i{foo}} prints foo in
-% italics, not bold italics.
-%
-\def\setfontstyle#1{%
-  \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
-  \csname ten#1\endcsname  % change the current font
-}
-
-% Select #1 fonts with the current style.
-%
-\def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
-
-\def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
-\def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
-\def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
-\def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
-\def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
+% Font-change commands.
 
 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
-% So we set up a \sf.
+% So we set up a \sf analogous to plain's \rm, etc.
 \newfam\sffam
-\def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
+\def\sf{\fam=\sffam \tensf}
 \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
 
-% We don't need math for this font style.
-\def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
-
+% We don't need math for this one.
+\def\ttsl{\tenttsl}
 
 % Default leading.
 \newdimen\textleading  \textleading = 13.2pt
@@ -1628,12 +1280,8 @@
 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
 %
-% can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
-\def\baselinefactor{1}
-%
 \def\setleading#1{%
-  \dimen0 = #1\relax
-  \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
+  \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax
   \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
   \normalbaselines
   \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
@@ -1642,279 +1290,10 @@
   }%
 }
 
-% PDF CMaps.  See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
-%
-% do nothing with this by default.
-\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
-\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
-\expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
-
-% if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
-% (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
-% older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
-\ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\undefined \else
-  \begingroup
-    \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
-    \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
-%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
-%%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
-%%Version: 1.000
-%%EndComments
-/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
-12 dict begin
-begincmap
-/CIDSystemInfo
-<< /Registry (TeX)
-/Ordering (OT1)
-/Supplement 0
->> def
-/CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
-/CMapType 2 def
-1 begincodespacerange
-<00> <7F>
-endcodespacerange
-8 beginbfrange
-<00> <01> <0393>
-<09> <0A> <03A8>
-<23> <26> <0023>
-<28> <3B> <0028>
-<3F> <5B> <003F>
-<5D> <5E> <005D>
-<61> <7A> <0061>
-<7B> <7C> <2013>
-endbfrange
-40 beginbfchar
-<02> <0398>
-<03> <039B>
-<04> <039E>
-<05> <03A0>
-<06> <03A3>
-<07> <03D2>
-<08> <03A6>
-<0B> <00660066>
-<0C> <00660069>
-<0D> <0066006C>
-<0E> <006600660069>
-<0F> <00660066006C>
-<10> <0131>
-<11> <0237>
-<12> <0060>
-<13> <00B4>
-<14> <02C7>
-<15> <02D8>
-<16> <00AF>
-<17> <02DA>
-<18> <00B8>
-<19> <00DF>
-<1A> <00E6>
-<1B> <0153>
-<1C> <00F8>
-<1D> <00C6>
-<1E> <0152>
-<1F> <00D8>
-<21> <0021>
-<22> <201D>
-<27> <2019>
-<3C> <00A1>
-<3D> <003D>
-<3E> <00BF>
-<5C> <201C>
-<5F> <02D9>
-<60> <2018>
-<7D> <02DD>
-<7E> <007E>
-<7F> <00A8>
-endbfchar
-endcmap
-CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
-end
-end
-%%EndResource
-%%EOF
-    }\endgroup
-  \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
-    \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
-  }%
-%
-% \cmapOT1IT
-  \begingroup
-    \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
-    \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
-%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
-%%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
-%%Version: 1.000
-%%EndComments
-/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
-12 dict begin
-begincmap
-/CIDSystemInfo
-<< /Registry (TeX)
-/Ordering (OT1IT)
-/Supplement 0
->> def
-/CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
-/CMapType 2 def
-1 begincodespacerange
-<00> <7F>
-endcodespacerange
-8 beginbfrange
-<00> <01> <0393>
-<09> <0A> <03A8>
-<25> <26> <0025>
-<28> <3B> <0028>
-<3F> <5B> <003F>
-<5D> <5E> <005D>
-<61> <7A> <0061>
-<7B> <7C> <2013>
-endbfrange
-42 beginbfchar
-<02> <0398>
-<03> <039B>
-<04> <039E>
-<05> <03A0>
-<06> <03A3>
-<07> <03D2>
-<08> <03A6>
-<0B> <00660066>
-<0C> <00660069>
-<0D> <0066006C>
-<0E> <006600660069>
-<0F> <00660066006C>
-<10> <0131>
-<11> <0237>
-<12> <0060>
-<13> <00B4>
-<14> <02C7>
-<15> <02D8>
-<16> <00AF>
-<17> <02DA>
-<18> <00B8>
-<19> <00DF>
-<1A> <00E6>
-<1B> <0153>
-<1C> <00F8>
-<1D> <00C6>
-<1E> <0152>
-<1F> <00D8>
-<21> <0021>
-<22> <201D>
-<23> <0023>
-<24> <00A3>
-<27> <2019>
-<3C> <00A1>
-<3D> <003D>
-<3E> <00BF>
-<5C> <201C>
-<5F> <02D9>
-<60> <2018>
-<7D> <02DD>
-<7E> <007E>
-<7F> <00A8>
-endbfchar
-endcmap
-CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
-end
-end
-%%EndResource
-%%EOF
-    }\endgroup
-  \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
-    \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
-  }%
-%
-% \cmapOT1TT
-  \begingroup
-    \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
-    \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
-%%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
-%%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
-%%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
-%%Version: 1.000
-%%EndComments
-/CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
-12 dict begin
-begincmap
-/CIDSystemInfo
-<< /Registry (TeX)
-/Ordering (OT1TT)
-/Supplement 0
->> def
-/CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
-/CMapType 2 def
-1 begincodespacerange
-<00> <7F>
-endcodespacerange
-5 beginbfrange
-<00> <01> <0393>
-<09> <0A> <03A8>
-<21> <26> <0021>
-<28> <5F> <0028>
-<61> <7E> <0061>
-endbfrange
-32 beginbfchar
-<02> <0398>
-<03> <039B>
-<04> <039E>
-<05> <03A0>
-<06> <03A3>
-<07> <03D2>
-<08> <03A6>
-<0B> <2191>
-<0C> <2193>
-<0D> <0027>
-<0E> <00A1>
-<0F> <00BF>
-<10> <0131>
-<11> <0237>
-<12> <0060>
-<13> <00B4>
-<14> <02C7>
-<15> <02D8>
-<16> <00AF>
-<17> <02DA>
-<18> <00B8>
-<19> <00DF>
-<1A> <00E6>
-<1B> <0153>
-<1C> <00F8>
-<1D> <00C6>
-<1E> <0152>
-<1F> <00D8>
-<20> <2423>
-<27> <2019>
-<60> <2018>
-<7F> <00A8>
-endbfchar
-endcmap
-CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
-end
-end
-%%EndResource
-%%EOF
-    }\endgroup
-  \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
-    \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
-  }%
-\fi\fi
-
-
 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
 % specified font prefix (normally `cm').
-% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
-% encoding (currently only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, pass
-% empty to omit).
-\def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
-  \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
-  \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
-}
-% This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
-\let\cmap\gobble
-% emacs-page end of cmaps
+% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor
+\def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4}
 
 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
@@ -1939,297 +1318,110 @@
 \def\scshape{csc}
 \def\scbshape{csc}
 
-% Definitions for a main text size of 11pt.  This is the default in
-% Texinfo.
-% 
-\def\definetextfontsizexi{%
-% Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
-\def\textnominalsize{11pt}
-\edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
-\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
+\newcount\mainmagstep
+\ifx\bigger\relax
+  % not really supported.
+  \mainmagstep=\magstep1
+  \setfont\textrm\rmshape{12}{1000}
+  \setfont\texttt\ttshape{12}{1000}
+\else
+  \mainmagstep=\magstephalf
+  \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+  \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\fi
+% Instead of cmb10, you may want to use cmbx10.
+% cmbx10 is a prettier font on its own, but cmb10
+% looks better when embedded in a line with cmr10
+% (in Bob's opinion).
+\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
-\def\textecsize{1095}
 
-% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
-\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
+% A few fonts for @defun, etc.
+\setfont\defbf\bxshape{10}{\magstep1} %was 1314
+\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}
+\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \bf}
 
 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
-\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}
+\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}
+\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}
+\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}
+\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}
+\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}
+\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}
+\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}
 \font\smalli=cmmi9
 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
-\def\smallecsize{0900}
 
 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
-\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
-\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
+\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}
+\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}
+\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}
+\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}
+\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}
+\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}
+\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}
 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
-\def\smallerecsize{0800}
 
-% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
-\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
-\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
-\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
-\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+% Fonts for title page:
+\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}
+\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}
+\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}
+\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}
 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
-\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
+\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}
 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
 \def\authorrm{\secrm}
 \def\authortt{\sectt}
-\def\titleecsize{2074}
 
 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
-\def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
-\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
-\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}
 \let\chapbf=\chaprm
-\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
+\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}
 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
-\def\chapecsize{1728}
 
 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
-\def\secnominalsize{14pt}
-\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
+\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}
+\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}
+\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}
 \let\secbf\secrm
-\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
+\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}
 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
-\def\sececsize{1440}
 
 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
-\def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
-\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
+\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
+\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}
+\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}
+\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
+\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}
+\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
-\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
+\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}
 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
-\def\ssececsize{1200}
-
-% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
-\def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
-\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\font\reducedi=cmmi10
-\font\reducedsy=cmsy10
-\def\reducedecsize{1000}
-
-% reset the current fonts
-\textfonts
-\rm
-} % end of 11pt text font size definitions
-
-
-% Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
-% section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit.  This is for the GNU
-% Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual.  Maybe other manuals in the
-% future.  Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
-% 
-\def\definetextfontsizex{%
-% Text fonts (10pt).
-\def\textnominalsize{10pt}
-\edef\mainmagstep{1000}
-\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
-\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
-\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
-\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
-\def\textecsize{1000}
-
-% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
-\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
-\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
-\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
-
-% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
-\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
-\font\smalli=cmmi9
-\font\smallsy=cmsy9
-\def\smallecsize{0900}
-
-% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
-\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
-\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
-\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
-\font\smalleri=cmmi8
-\font\smallersy=cmsy8
-\def\smallerecsize{0800}
-
-% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
-\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
-\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
-\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
-\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\let\titlebf=\titlerm
-\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
-\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
-\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
-\def\authorrm{\secrm}
-\def\authortt{\sectt}
-\def\titleecsize{2074}
-
-% Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
-\def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
-\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\let\chapbf\chaprm
-\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
-\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
-\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
-\def\chapecsize{1440}
-
-% Section fonts (12pt).
-\def\secnominalsize{12pt}
-\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\let\secbf\secrm
-\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
-\font\seci=cmmi12 
-\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
-\def\sececsize{1200}
-
-% Subsection fonts (10pt).
-\def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
-\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
-\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
-\font\sseci=cmmi10
-\font\ssecsy=cmsy10
-\def\ssececsize{1000}
-
-% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
-\def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
-\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
-\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
-\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
-\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
-\font\reducedi=cmmi9
-\font\reducedsy=cmsy9
-\def\reducedecsize{0900}
-
-% reduce space between paragraphs
-\divide\parskip by 2
-
-% reset the current fonts
-\textfonts
-\rm
-} % end of 10pt text font size definitions
-
-
-% We provide the user-level command
-%   @fonttextsize 10
-% (or 11) to redefine the text font size.  pt is assumed.
-% 
-\def\xword{10}
-\def\xiword{11}
-%
-\parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
-  \def\textsizearg{#1}%
-  \wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
-  %
-  % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
-  % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
-  % 
- \begingroup \globaldefs=1
-  \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
-  \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
-  \else
-    \errhelp=\EMsimple
-    \errmessage{ fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
-  \fi\fi
- \endgroup
-}
-
+% The smallcaps and symbol fonts should actually be scaled \magstep1.5,
+% but that is not a standard magnification.
 
 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families.  Since
@@ -2244,81 +1436,50 @@
 }
 
 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
-% of just \STYLE.  We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
-% current \fam for math mode.  Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
-% \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
-%
-% Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
-% and \lllsize (three sizes lower).  These relative commands are used in
-% the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
-%
-% This all needs generalizing, badly.
-%
+% of just \STYLE.  We do this so that font changes will continue to work
+% in math mode, where it is the current \fam that is relevant in most
+% cases, not the current font.  Plain TeX does \def\bf{\fam=\bffam
+% \tenbf}, for example.  By redefining \tenbf, we obviate the need to
+% redefine \bf itself.
 \def\textfonts{%
   \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
   \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
-  \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
-  \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
-  \def\curfontsize{text}%
-  \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
+  \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
   \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
 \def\titlefonts{%
   \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl
   \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc
   \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy
   \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
-  \def\curfontsize{title}%
-  \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
   \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}}
 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
 \def\chapfonts{%
   \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
   \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
-  \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
-  \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
-  \def\curfontsize{chap}%
-  \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}%
+  \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
   \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}}
 \def\secfonts{%
   \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
   \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
-  \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
-  \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
-  \def\curfontsize{sec}%
-  \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
+  \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
   \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}}
 \def\subsecfonts{%
   \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
   \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
-  \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
-  \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
-  \def\curfontsize{ssec}%
-  \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}%
+  \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
   \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}}
-\let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts
-\def\reducedfonts{%
-  \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl
-  \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc
-  \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy
-  \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl
-  \def\curfontsize{reduced}%
-  \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
-  \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
+\let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts % Maybe make sssec fonts scaled magstephalf?
 \def\smallfonts{%
   \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl
   \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc
   \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy
   \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl
-  \def\curfontsize{small}%
-  \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
   \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
 \def\smallerfonts{%
   \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl
   \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc
   \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy
   \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl
-  \def\curfontsize{smaller}%
-  \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
   \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
 
 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
@@ -2327,7 +1488,7 @@
 % About \smallexamplefonts.  If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
 % can fit this many characters:
 %   8.5x11=86   smallbook=72  a4=90  a5=69
-% If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
+% If we use \smallerfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
 %   8.5x11=90+  smallbook=80  a4=90+  a5=77
 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
 % the additional smallness of 8pt.  So I'm making the default 9pt.
@@ -2335,13 +1496,14 @@
 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
 %   8.5x11=71  smallbook=60  a4=75  a5=58
 %
-% I wish the USA used A4 paper.
+% I wish we used A4 paper on this side of the Atlantic.
+%
 % --karl, 24jan03.
 
 
 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
 %
-\definetextfontsizexi
+\textfonts
 
 % Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
 \def\angleleft{$\langle$}
@@ -2351,10 +1513,10 @@
 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
 
 % Fonts for short table of contents.
-\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}  % no cmb12
-\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
-\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
+\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}
+\setfont\shortcontbf\bxshape{12}{1000}
+\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}
+\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}
 
 %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
 %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
@@ -2366,27 +1528,15 @@
 \def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
 \def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
 
-% like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
-% @var is set to this for defun arguments.
-\def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
-
-% like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl.  We never want
-% ttsl for book titles, do we?
-\def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
-
 \let\i=\smartitalic
-\let\slanted=\smartslanted
 \let\var=\smartslanted
 \let\dfn=\smartslanted
 \let\emph=\smartitalic
+\let\cite=\smartslanted
 
-% @b, explicit bold.
 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
 \let\strong=\b
 
-% @sansserif, explicit sans.
-\def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
-
 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
 % the end of a paragraph.  Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
@@ -2399,25 +1549,19 @@
 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
 %
 \catcode` =11
-  \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
+  \def\frenchspacing{%
     \sfcode\dotChar  =\ m \sfcode\questChar=\ m \sfcode\exclamChar=\ m
     \sfcode\colonChar=\ m \sfcode\semiChar =\ m \sfcode\commaChar =\ m
-    \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
-  }
-  \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
-    \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
-    \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
-    \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
   }
 \catcode` =\other
-\def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
 
 \def\t#1{%
-  {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
+  {\tt \rawbackslash \frenchspacing #1}%
   \null
 }
+\let\ttfont=\t
 \def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null}
-\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
+\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
 \font\keysy=cmsy9
 \def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
   \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
@@ -2425,7 +1569,6 @@
      \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
     \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
   \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
-\def\key #1{{\nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
 % The old definition, with no lozenge:
 %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
@@ -2451,13 +1594,13 @@
     \nohyphenation
     %
     \rawbackslash
-    \plainfrenchspacing
+    \frenchspacing
     #1%
   }%
   \null
 }
 
-% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
+% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in \code.
 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
 
@@ -2467,23 +1610,18 @@
 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
 %  -- rms.
 {
-  \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
-  \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
+  \catcode`\-=\active
+  \catcode`\_=\active
   %
   \global\def\code{\begingroup
-    \catcode\rquoteChar=\active \catcode\lquoteChar=\active
-    \let'\codequoteright \let`\codequoteleft
-    %
-    \catcode\dashChar=\active  \catcode\underChar=\active
-    \ifallowcodebreaks
-     \let-\codedash
-     \let_\codeunder
-    \else
-     \let-\realdash
-     \let_\realunder
-    \fi
+    \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash
+    \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder
     \codex
   }
+  %
+  % If we end up with any active - characters when handling the index,
+  % just treat them as a normal -.
+  \global\def\indexbreaks{\catcode`\-=\active \let-\realdash}
 }
 
 \def\realdash{-}
@@ -2501,45 +1639,24 @@
 }
 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
 
-% An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
-% each of the four underscores in __typeof__.  This is undesirable in
-% some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
-% general.  @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
-% 
-\newif\ifallowcodebreaks  \allowcodebreakstrue
-
-\def\keywordtrue{true}
-\def\keywordfalse{false}
-
-\parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
-  \def\txiarg{#1}%
-  \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
-    \allowcodebreakstrue
-  \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
-    \allowcodebreaksfalse
-  \else
-    \errhelp = \EMsimple
-    \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg'}%
-  \fi\fi
-}
-
 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
 % then @kbd has no effect.
 
 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
 %   `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
 %   or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
-\parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
-  \def\txiarg{#1}%
-  \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
+\def\kbdinputstyle{\parsearg\kbdinputstylexxx}
+\def\kbdinputstylexxx#1{%
+  \def\arg{#1}%
+  \ifx\arg\worddistinct
     \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
-  \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
+  \else\ifx\arg\wordexample
     \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
-  \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
+  \else\ifx\arg\wordcode
     \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
   \else
     \errhelp = \EMsimple
-    \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\txiarg'}%
+    \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\arg'}%
   \fi\fi\fi
 }
 \def\worddistinct{distinct}
@@ -2555,8 +1672,8 @@
 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi
 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi}
 
-% For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
-\let\indicateurl=\code
+% For @url, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
+\let\url=\code
 \let\env=\code
 \let\command=\code
 
@@ -2588,10 +1705,6 @@
   \endlink
 \endgroup}
 
-% @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
-%
-\let\url=\uref
-
 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
 %
@@ -2633,140 +1746,22 @@
 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}}       % smallcaps font
 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}}             % italic font
 
-% @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
-% We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
-% all-uppercase.
-% 
-\def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
-\def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
-  {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
-  \def\temp{#2}%
-  \ifx\temp\empty \else
-    \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
-  \fi
-}
-
-% @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
-% No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
-% 
-\def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
-\def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
-  {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
-  \def\temp{#2}%
-  \ifx\temp\empty \else
-    \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
-  \fi
-}
+% @acronym downcases the argument and prints in smallcaps.
+\def\acronym#1{{\smallcaps \lowercase{#1}}}
 
-% @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
-%
+% @pounds{} is a sterling sign.
 \def\pounds{{\it\$}}
 
-% @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
-% We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
-% Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
-% "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
-% It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
-% 
-% Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
-% that.  The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
-% font height.
-% 
-% feymr - regular
-% feymo - slanted
-% feybr - bold
-% feybo - bold slanted
-% 
-% There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
-% A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
-% Hmm.
-% 
-% Also doesn't work in math.  Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
-% Hope not.
-% 
-% 
-\def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
-\def\eurofont{%
-  % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
-  % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
-  % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
-  % font installed.
-  % 
-  % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
-  % that to the current nominal size.
-  % 
-  % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
-  % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
-  % 
-  \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
-  %
-  \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename 
-    % bold:
-    \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
-  \else 
-    % regular:
-    \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
-  \fi
-  \thiseurofont
-}
-
-% Hacks for glyphs from the EC fonts similar to \euro.  We don't
-% use \let for the aliases, because sometimes we redefine the original
-% macro, and the alias should reflect the redefinition.
-\def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
-\def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
-\def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
-\def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
-\def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
-\def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
-\def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
-\def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
-%
-\def\ecfont{%
-  % We can't distinguish serif/sanserif and italic/slanted, but this
-  % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
-  % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
-  % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
-  \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
-  \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
-  \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
-    % bold:
-    \font\thisecfont = ecb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
-  \else
-    % regular:
-    \font\thisecfont = ec\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
-  \fi
-  \thisecfont
-}
-
-% @registeredsymbol - R in a circle.  The font for the R should really
-% be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
+% @registeredsymbol - R in a circle.  For now, only works in text size;
+% we'd have to redo the font mechanism to change the \scriptstyle and
+% \scriptscriptstyle font sizes to make it look right in headings.
 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
 %
 \def\registeredsymbol{%
-  $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}%
-               \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
+  $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{$\scriptstyle\rm R$}\hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
     }$%
 }
 
-% @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
-%
-\def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
-
-% Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
-%  Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14)  (68K)  16 APR 2004 02:38
-% so we'll define it if necessary.
-% 
-\ifx\Orb\undefined
-\def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
-\fi
-
-% Quotes.
-\chardef\quotedblleft="5C
-\chardef\quotedblright=`\"
-\chardef\quoteleft=`\`
-\chardef\quoteright=`\'
-
 
 \message{page headings,}
 
@@ -2785,103 +1780,87 @@
 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
  \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
 
-\parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
+\def\shorttitlepage{\parsearg\shorttitlepagezzz}
+\def\shorttitlepagezzz #1{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
         \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
 
-\envdef\titlepage{%
-  % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
-  \begingroup
-    \parindent=0pt \textfonts
-    % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
-    \vglue\titlepagetopglue
-    % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
-    \finishedtitlepagetrue
-    %
-    % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
-    % at the top of the second.  We don't want the ragged left on the second.
-    \let\oldpage = \page
-    \def\page{%
+\def\titlepage{\begingroup \parindent=0pt \textfonts
+   \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
+   \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}%
+   %
+   \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines
+                   \let\tt=\authortt}%
+   %
+   % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
+   \vglue\titlepagetopglue
+   %
+   % Now you can print the title using @title.
+   \def\title{\parsearg\titlezzz}%
+   \def\titlezzz##1{\leftline{\titlefonts\rm ##1}
+                    % print a rule at the page bottom also.
+                    \finishedtitlepagefalse
+                    \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt}%
+   % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
+   \finishedtitlepagetrue
+   %
+   % Now you can put text using @subtitle.
+   \def\subtitle{\parsearg\subtitlezzz}%
+   \def\subtitlezzz##1{{\subtitlefont \rightline{##1}}}%
+   %
+   % @author should come last, but may come many times.
+   \def\author{\parsearg\authorzzz}%
+   \def\authorzzz##1{\ifseenauthor\else\vskip 0pt plus 1filll\seenauthortrue\fi
+      {\authorfont \leftline{##1}}}%
+   %
+   % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
+   % at the top of the second.  We don't want the ragged left on the second.
+   \let\oldpage = \page
+   \def\page{%
       \iffinishedtitlepage\else
-	 \finishtitlepage
+         \finishtitlepage
       \fi
+      \oldpage
       \let\page = \oldpage
-      \page
-      \null
-    }%
+      \hbox{}}%
+%   \def\page{\oldpage \hbox{}}
 }
 
 \def\Etitlepage{%
-    \iffinishedtitlepage\else
-	\finishtitlepage
-    \fi
-    % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
-    % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
-    % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
-    % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
-    \oldpage
-  \endgroup
-  %
-  % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
-  % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
-  \HEADINGSon
-  %
-  % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
-  \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
-    \shortcontents
-    \contents
-    \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
-    \global\let\contents = \relax
-  \fi
-  %
-  \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
-    \contents
-    \global\let\contents = \relax
-    \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
-  \fi
+   \iffinishedtitlepage\else
+      \finishtitlepage
+   \fi
+   % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
+   % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
+   % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
+   % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
+   \oldpage
+   \endgroup
+   %
+   % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
+   % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
+   \HEADINGSon
+   %
+   % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
+   \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
+     \shortcontents
+     \contents
+     \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
+     \global\let\contents = \relax
+   \fi
+   %
+   \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
+     \contents
+     \global\let\contents = \relax
+     \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
+   \fi
 }
 
 \def\finishtitlepage{%
-  \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
-  \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
-  \finishedtitlepagetrue
-}
-
-%%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
-
-\let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
-\def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
-
-\def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines
-		\let\tt=\authortt}
-
-\parseargdef\title{%
-  \checkenv\titlepage
-  \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1}
-  % print a rule at the page bottom also.
-  \finishedtitlepagefalse
-  \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
-}
-
-\parseargdef\subtitle{%
-  \checkenv\titlepage
-  {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
-}
-
-% @author should come last, but may come many times.
-% It can also be used inside @quotation.
-%
-\parseargdef\author{%
-  \def\temp{\quotation}%
-  \ifx\thisenv\temp
-    \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
-  \else
-    \checkenv\titlepage
-    \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
-    {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}%
-  \fi
+   \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
+   \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
+   \finishedtitlepagetrue
 }
 
-
 %%% Set up page headings and footings.
 
 \let\thispage=\folio
@@ -2891,7 +1870,7 @@
 \newtoks\evenfootline    % footline on even pages
 \newtoks\oddfootline     % footline on odd pages
 
-% Now make TeX use those variables
+% Now make Tex use those variables
 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
                             \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
@@ -2905,64 +1884,43 @@
 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
 
-
 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
-\def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
+\def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
+\def\everyheading{\parsearg\everyheadingxxx}
+
+\def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
+\def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
+\def\everyfooting{\parsearg\everyfootingxxx}
+
+{\catcode`\ =0 %
+
+\gdef\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
+\gdef\evenheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
 
-\def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
-\def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
+\gdef\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
+\gdef\oddheadingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
 
-\parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
+\gdef\everyheadingxxx#1{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
 
-\def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
-\def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
+\gdef\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
+\gdef\evenfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
 
-\def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
-\def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
-\def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
+\gdef\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1@|@|@|@|\finish}
+\gdef\oddfootingyyy #1@|#2@|#3@|#4\finish{%
   \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
   %
   % Leave some space for the footline.  Hopefully ok to assume
   % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
-  \global\advance\pageheight by -12pt
-  \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
+  \global\advance\pageheight by -\baselineskip
+  \global\advance\vsize by -\baselineskip
 }
 
-\parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
-
-% @evenheadingmarks top     \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
-% @evenheadingmarks bottom  \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
+\gdef\everyfootingxxx#1{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
 %
-% The same set of arguments for:
-%
-% @oddheadingmarks
-% @evenfootingmarks
-% @oddfootingmarks
-% @everyheadingmarks
-% @everyfootingmarks
-
-\def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
-\def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
-\def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
-\def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
-\def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
-                          \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
-\def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
-                          \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
-% #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
-\def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
-  \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
-  \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
-}
-
-\everyheadingmarks bottom
-\everyfootingmarks bottom
+}% unbind the catcode of @.
 
 % @headings double      turns headings on for double-sided printing.
 % @headings single      turns headings on for single-sided printing.
@@ -2976,7 +1934,7 @@
 
 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
 
-\def\HEADINGSoff{%
+\def\HEADINGSoff{
 \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
 \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}}
 \HEADINGSoff
@@ -2985,7 +1943,7 @@
 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
 % edge of all pages.
-\def\HEADINGSdouble{%
+\def\HEADINGSdouble{
 \global\pageno=1
 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
@@ -2997,7 +1955,7 @@
 
 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
 % page number on top right.
-\def\HEADINGSsingle{%
+\def\HEADINGSsingle{
 \global\pageno=1
 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
@@ -3044,11 +2002,12 @@
 % @settitle line...  specifies the title of the document, for headings.
 % It generates no output of its own.
 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
-\def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
+\def\settitle{\parsearg\settitlezzz}
+\def\settitlezzz #1{\gdef\thistitle{#1}}
 
 
 \message{tables,}
-% Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
+% Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x), @kitem(x), @xitem(x).
 
 % default indentation of table text
 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
@@ -3060,7 +2019,7 @@
 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
 \newdimen\itemmax
 
-% Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
+% Note @table, @vtable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
 % these defs.
 % They also define \itemindex
 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
@@ -3072,10 +2031,22 @@
 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
 
+\def\internalBxitem "#1"{\def\xitemsubtopix{#1} \smallbreak \parsearg\xitemzzz}
+\def\internalBxitemx "#1"{\def\xitemsubtopix{#1} \itemxpar \parsearg\xitemzzz}
+
+\def\internalBkitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\kitemzzz}
+\def\internalBkitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\kitemzzz}
+
+\def\kitemzzz #1{\dosubind {kw}{\code{#1}}{for {\bf \lastfunction}}%
+                 \itemzzz {#1}}
+
+\def\xitemzzz #1{\dosubind {kw}{\code{#1}}{for {\bf \xitemsubtopic}}%
+                 \itemzzz {#1}}
+
 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
   \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
   \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
-  \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
+  \setbox0=\hbox{\itemfont{#1}}%
   \itemindex{#1}%
   \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
   %
@@ -3099,13 +2070,17 @@
     % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
     \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
     %
-    % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up.  However, if
-    % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
-    % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
-    % cause the example and the item to crash together.  So we use this
-    % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
-    % \parskip glue after all.  Section titles are handled this way also.
-    % 
+    % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up.  (Unfortunately
+    % we can't prevent a possible page break at the following
+    % \baselineskip glue.)  However, if what follows is an environment
+    % such as @example, there will be no \parskip glue; then
+    % the negative vskip we just would cause the example and the item to
+    % crash together.  So we use this bizarre value of 10001 as a signal
+    % to \aboveenvbreak to insert \parskip glue after all.
+    % (Possibly there are other commands that could be followed by
+    % @example which need the same treatment, but not section titles; or
+    % maybe section titles are the only special case and they should be
+    % penalty 10001...)
     \penalty 10001
     \endgroup
     \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
@@ -3125,72 +2100,81 @@
   \fi
 }
 
-\def\item{\errmessage{ item while not in a list environment}}
-\def\itemx{\errmessage{ itemx while not in a list environment}}
+\def\item{\errmessage{ item while not in a table}}
+\def\itemx{\errmessage{ itemx while not in a table}}
+\def\kitem{\errmessage{ kitem while not in a table}}
+\def\kitemx{\errmessage{ kitemx while not in a table}}
+\def\xitem{\errmessage{ xitem while not in a table}}
+\def\xitemx{\errmessage{ xitemx while not in a table}}
+
+% Contains a kludge to get @end[description] to work.
+\def\description{\tablez{\dontindex}{1}{}{}{}{}}
 
 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
-\envdef\table{%
-  \let\itemindex\gobble
-  \tablecheck{table}%
-}
-\envdef\ftable{%
-  \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
-  \tablecheck{ftable}%
-}
-\envdef\vtable{%
-  \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
-  \tablecheck{vtable}%
-}
-\def\tablecheck#1{%
-  \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
-    \endgroup
-    \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
-      that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
-    \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
-  \else
-    \let\next\tablex
-  \fi
-  \next
-}
-\def\tablex#1{%
-  \def\itemindicate{#1}%
-  \parsearg\tabley
-}
-\def\tabley#1{%
-  {%
-    \makevalueexpandable
-    \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
-    \expandafter
-  }\temp \endtablez
+\def\table{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\tablex}
+{\obeylines\obeyspaces%
+\gdef\tablex #1^^M{%
+\tabley\dontindex#1        \endtabley}}
+
+\def\ftable{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\ftablex}
+{\obeylines\obeyspaces%
+\gdef\ftablex #1^^M{%
+\tabley\fnitemindex#1        \endtabley
+\def\Eftable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
+\let\Etable=\relax}}
+
+\def\vtable{\begingroup\inENV\obeylines\obeyspaces\vtablex}
+{\obeylines\obeyspaces%
+\gdef\vtablex #1^^M{%
+\tabley\vritemindex#1        \endtabley
+\def\Evtable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
+\let\Etable=\relax}}
+
+\def\dontindex #1{}
+\def\fnitemindex #1{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}}%
+\def\vritemindex #1{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}}%
+
+{\obeyspaces %
+\gdef\tabley#1#2 #3 #4 #5 #6 #7\endtabley{\endgroup%
+\tablez{#1}{#2}{#3}{#4}{#5}{#6}}}
+
+\def\tablez #1#2#3#4#5#6{%
+\aboveenvbreak %
+\begingroup %
+\def\Edescription{\Etable}% Necessary kludge.
+\let\itemindex=#1%
+\ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \leftskip by #3\mil \fi %
+\ifnum 0#4>0 \tableindent=#4\mil \fi %
+\ifnum 0#5>0 \advance \rightskip by #5\mil \fi %
+\def\itemfont{#2}%
+\itemmax=\tableindent %
+\advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin %
+\advance \leftskip by \tableindent %
+\exdentamount=\tableindent
+\parindent = 0pt
+\parskip = \smallskipamount
+\ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi%
+\def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
+\let\item = \internalBitem %
+\let\itemx = \internalBitemx %
+\let\kitem = \internalBkitem %
+\let\kitemx = \internalBkitemx %
+\let\xitem = \internalBxitem %
+\let\xitemx = \internalBxitemx %
 }
-\def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
-  \aboveenvbreak
-  \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
-  \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
-  \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
-  \itemmax=\tableindent
-  \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
-  \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
-  \exdentamount=\tableindent
-  \parindent = 0pt
-  \parskip = \smallskipamount
-  \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
-  \let\item = \internalBitem
-  \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
-}
-\def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
-\let\Eftable\Etable
-\let\Evtable\Etable
-\let\Eitemize\Etable
-\let\Eenumerate\Etable
 
 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
 
 \newcount \itemno
 
-\envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
+\def\itemize{\parsearg\itemizezzz}
+
+\def\itemizezzz #1{%
+  \begingroup % ended by the @end itemize
+  \itemizey {#1}{\Eitemize}
+}
 
-\def\doitemize#1{%
+\def\itemizey#1#2{%
   \aboveenvbreak
   \itemmax=\itemindent
   \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
@@ -3199,33 +2183,13 @@
   \parindent=0pt
   \parskip=\smallskipamount
   \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
+  \def#2{\endgraf\afterenvbreak\endgroup}%
   \def\itemcontents{#1}%
   % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
   \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
   \let\item=\itemizeitem
 }
 
-% Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
-%
-\def\itemizeitem{%
-  \advance\itemno by 1  % for enumerations
-  {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
-  {%
-   % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
-   % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
-   % done a \vskip-\parskip.  In that case, we don't want to zero
-   % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading.  On the
-   % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
-   % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
-   % space.  In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before.  At least
-   % that's the theory.
-   \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
-   \noindent
-   \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
-   \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
-  \flushcr
-}
-
 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
 %
@@ -3235,8 +2199,11 @@
 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list.  No
 % argument is the same as `1'.
 %
-\envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1  \endenumeratey}
+\def\enumerate{\parsearg\enumeratezzz}
+\def\enumeratezzz #1{\enumeratey #1  \endenumeratey}
 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
+  \begingroup % ended by the @end enumerate
+  %
   % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
   \def\thearg{#1}%
   \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
@@ -3307,13 +2274,13 @@
   }%
 }
 
-% Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
+% Call itemizey, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
 % common last two arguments.  Also subtract one from the initial value in
 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
 %
 \def\startenumeration#1{%
   \advance\itemno by -1
-  \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
+  \itemizey{#1.}\Eenumerate\flushcr
 }
 
 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
@@ -3324,6 +2291,16 @@
 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
 
+% Definition of @item while inside @itemize.
+
+\def\itemizeitem{%
+\advance\itemno by 1
+{\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}%
+\ifhmode \errmessage{In hmode at itemizeitem}\fi
+{\parskip=0in \hskip 0pt
+\hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents\hskip \itemmargin}%
+\vadjust{\penalty 1200}}%
+\flushcr}
 
 % @multitable macros
 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
@@ -3350,14 +2327,24 @@
 %   @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
 %   @item ...
 %   using the widest term desired in each column.
+%
+% For those who want to use more than one line's worth of words in
+% the preamble, break the line within one argument and it
+% will parse correctly, i.e.,
+%
+%     @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3
+%      template}
+% Not:
+%     @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template}
+%      {Column 3 template}
 
 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
 % ie, @tab tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
 
-% @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
-% if they are.
+% @item, @tab, @multitable or @end multitable do not need to be on their
+% own lines, but it will not hurt if they are.
 
 % Sample multitable:
 
@@ -3401,12 +2388,13 @@
 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
 \newif\ifsetpercent
 
-% #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
-% be just 1.  We just use it, whatever it is.
-%
-\def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
+% #1 is the part of the @columnfraction before the decimal point, which
+% is presumably either 0 or the empty string (but we don't check, we
+% just throw it away).  #2 is the decimal part, which we use as the
+% percent of \hsize for this column.
+\def\pickupwholefraction#1.#2 {%
   \global\advance\colcount by 1
-  \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
+  \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{.#2\hsize}%
   \setuptable
 }
 
@@ -3439,33 +2427,18 @@
   \go
 }
 
-% multitable-only commands.
-%
-% @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
-% Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
-% of an alignment entry.  Note that \everycr resets \everytab.
-\def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}%
-%
-% A \tab used to include \hskip1sp.  But then the space in a template
-% line is not enough.  That is bad.  So let's go back to just `&' until
-% we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
-%					--karl, nathan acm org, 20apr99.
-\def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
-
 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
 %
-\newtoks\everytab  % insert after every tab.
-%
-\envdef\multitable{%
+\def\multitable{\parsearg\dotable}
+\def\dotable#1{\bgroup
   \vskip\parskip
-  \startsavinginserts
-  %
-  % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
-  % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
-  % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
-  % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
-  \def\item{\crcr}%
-  %
+  \let\item=\crcrwithfootnotes
+  % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp.  But then the space in a template
+  % line is not enough.  That is bad.  So let's go back to just & until
+  % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.  --karl,
+  % nathan acm org, 20apr99.
+  \let\tab=&%
+  \let\startfootins=\startsavedfootnote
   \tolerance=9500
   \hbadness=9500
   \setmultitablespacing
@@ -3473,93 +2446,85 @@
   \parindent=\multitableparindent
   \overfullrule=0pt
   \global\colcount=0
-  %
-  \everycr = {%
-    \noalign{%
-      \global\everytab={}%
-      \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
-      % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
-      \checkinserts
-      % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
-      %\filbreak
-	% Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
-	% table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better?  Wait until the
-	% problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
-    }%
+  \def\Emultitable{%
+    \global\setpercentfalse
+    \crcrwithfootnotes\crcr
+    \egroup\egroup
   }%
   %
-  \parsearg\domultitable
-}
-\def\domultitable#1{%
   % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
   \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
   %
+  % \everycr will reset column counter, \colcount, at the end of
+  % each line. Every column entry will cause \colcount to advance by one.
+  % The table preamble
+  % looks at the current \colcount to find the correct column width.
+  \everycr{\noalign{%
+  %
+  % \filbreak%% keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
+  % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the table
+  % breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better?  Wait until the problem
+  % manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
+    \global\colcount=0\relax}}%
+  %
   % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
   % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
   % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
   % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
-  \halign\bgroup &%
-    \global\advance\colcount by 1
-    \multistrut
-    \vtop{%
-      % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
-      \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
-      %
-      % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
-      % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
-      % the first one.
-      %
-      % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
-      % to the width of each template entry.
-      %
-      % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
-      % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
-      % will keep entries from bumping into each other.  Table will start at
-      % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
-      %
-      % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
-      \rightskip=0pt
-      \ifnum\colcount=1
-	% The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
-	\advance\hsize by\leftskip
-      \else
-	\ifsetpercent \else
-	  % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
-	  % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
-	  \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
-	\fi
-       % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
-      \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
-      \fi
-      % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
-      % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
-      % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
-      % For example:
-      % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
-      % @item @code{#}
-      % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
-      % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
-      % marking characters.
-      \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
-    }\cr
-}
-\def\Emultitable{%
-  \crcr
-  \egroup % end the \halign
-  \global\setpercentfalse
-}
-
-\def\setmultitablespacing{%
-  \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
+  \halign\bgroup&\global\advance\colcount by 1\relax
+    \multistrut\vtop{\hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
   %
-  % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
-  % \multitableparskip calculation.  We used define \multistrut based on
-  % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
-  % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
+  % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
+  % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
+  % the first one.
+  %
+  % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
+  % to the width of each template entry.
+  %
+  % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
+  % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
+  % will keep entries from bumping into each other.  Table will start at
+  % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
+  %
+  % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
+  \rightskip=0pt
+  \ifnum\colcount=1
+    % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
+    \advance\hsize by\leftskip
+  \else
+    \ifsetpercent \else
+      % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
+      % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
+      \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
+    \fi
+   % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
+  \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
+  \fi
+  % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
+  % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
+  % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
+  % For example:
+  % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
+  % @item @code{#}
+  % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
+  % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively marking
+  % characters.
+  \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut}\cr
+}
+
+\def\setmultitablespacing{% test to see if user has set \multitablelinespace.
+% If so, do nothing. If not, give it an appropriate dimension based on
+% current baselineskip.
 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
-\fi
+%% strut to put in table in case some entry doesn't have descenders,
+%% to keep lines equally spaced
+\let\multistrut = \strut
+\else
+%% FIXME: what is \box0 supposed to be?
+\gdef\multistrut{\vrule height\multitablelinespace depth\dp0
+width0pt\relax} \fi
 %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
 %% table. If not, do nothing.
 %%        If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
@@ -3574,33 +2539,65 @@
                                       %% than skip between lines in the table.
 \fi}
 
+% In case a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
+% text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is
+% finished.  Otherwise, the insertion is lost, it never migrates to the
+% main vertical list.  --kasal, 22jan03.
+%
+\newbox\savedfootnotes
+%
+% \dotable \let's \startfootins to this, so that \dofootnote will call
+% it instead of starting the insertion right away.
+\def\startsavedfootnote{%
+  \global\setbox\savedfootnotes = \vbox\bgroup
+    \unvbox\savedfootnotes
+}
+\def\crcrwithfootnotes{%
+  \crcr
+  \ifvoid\savedfootnotes \else
+    \noalign{\insert\footins{\box\savedfootnotes}}%
+  \fi
+}
 
 \message{conditionals,}
-
-% @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
-% @ifnotxml always succeed.  They currently do nothing; we don't
-% attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested.  But we
-% have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
-% attempt to close an environment group.
-%
-\def\makecond#1{%
-  \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
-  \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
-}
-\makecond{iftex}
-\makecond{ifnotdocbook}
-\makecond{ifnothtml}
-\makecond{ifnotinfo}
-\makecond{ifnotplaintext}
-\makecond{ifnotxml}
+% Prevent errors for section commands.
+% Used in @ignore and in failing conditionals.
+\def\ignoresections{%
+  \let\appendix=\relax
+  \let\appendixsec=\relax
+  \let\appendixsection=\relax
+  \let\appendixsubsec=\relax
+  \let\appendixsubsection=\relax
+  \let\appendixsubsubsec=\relax
+  \let\appendixsubsubsection=\relax
+  %\let\begin=\relax
+  %\let\bye=\relax
+  \let\centerchap=\relax
+  \let\chapter=\relax
+  \let\contents=\relax
+  \let\section=\relax
+  \let\smallbook=\relax
+  \let\subsec=\relax
+  \let\subsection=\relax
+  \let\subsubsec=\relax
+  \let\subsubsection=\relax
+  \let\titlepage=\relax
+  \let\top=\relax
+  \let\unnumbered=\relax
+  \let\unnumberedsec=\relax
+  \let\unnumberedsection=\relax
+  \let\unnumberedsubsec=\relax
+  \let\unnumberedsubsection=\relax
+  \let\unnumberedsubsubsec=\relax
+  \let\unnumberedsubsubsection=\relax
+}
 
 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
 %
 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
+\def\documentdescriptionword{documentdescription}
 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
-\def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
 \def\html{\doignore{html}}
-\def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
@@ -3610,44 +2607,50 @@
 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
 
+% @dircategory CATEGORY  -- specify a category of the dir file
+% which this file should belong to.  Ignore this in TeX.
+\let\dircategory = \comment
+
 % Ignore text until a line ` end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
 %
 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
 \newcount\doignorecount
 
 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
-  % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
-  \obeylines
-  \catcode`\@ = \other
-  \catcode`\{ = \other
-  \catcode`\} = \other
+  % Don't complain about control sequences we have declared \outer.
+  \ignoresections
   %
   % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
-  \spaceisspace
+  \catcode\spaceChar = 10
+  %
+  % Ignore braces, so mismatched braces don't cause trouble.
+  \catcode`\{ = 9
+  \catcode`\} = 9
   %
   % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
   \doignorecount = 0
   %
   % Swallow text until we reach the matching ` end #1'.
-  \dodoignore{#1}%
+  \expandafter \dodoignore \csname#1\endcsname {#1}%
 }
 
-{ \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
+{ \catcode` =11 % We want to use \ST P which cannot appear in texinfo source.
   \obeylines %
   %
-  \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
-    % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
-    %
-    % Define a command to find the next ` end #1'.
-    \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M end #1{%
-      \doignoretextyyy##1^^M #1\_STOP_}%
-    %
+  \gdef\dodoignore#1#2{%
+    % #1 contains, e.g., \ifinfo, a.k.a. @ifinfo.
+    % #2 contains the string `ifinfo'.
+    %
+    % Define a command to find the next ` end #2', which must be on a line
+    % by itself.
+    \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M\end #2{\doignoretextyyy##1^^M#1\ST P}%
     % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
     % line.  (Otherwise, we would consider a line ` c @ifset', for
     % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
-    \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M #1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
+    \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M#1##2\ST P{\doignoreyyy{##2}\ST@P}%
     %
     % And now expand that command.
+    \obeylines %
     \doignoretext ^^M%
   }%
 }
@@ -3661,11 +2664,11 @@
     \let\next\doignoretextyyy		% ..., look for another.
     % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
   \fi
-  \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
+  \next #1% the token \ST P is present just after this macro.
 }
 
-% We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
-%
+% We have to swallow the remaining "\ST P".
+% 
 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
   \ifnum\doignorecount = 0	% We have just found the outermost @end.
     \let\next\enddoignore
@@ -3677,12 +2680,7 @@
 }
 
 % Finish off ignored text.
-{ \obeylines%
-  % Ignore anything after the last ` end #1'; this matters in verbatim
-  % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
-  % would result in a blank line in the output.
-  \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
-}
+\def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces}
 
 
 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
@@ -3691,58 +2689,53 @@
 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
-% didn't need it.
-% We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
+% didn't need it.  Make sure the catcode of space is correct to avoid
+% losing inside @example, for instance.
 %
-\parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
+\def\set{\begingroup\catcode` =10
+  \catcode`\-=12 \catcode`\_=12 % Allow - and _ in VAR.
+  \parsearg\setxxx}
+\def\setxxx#1{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
-  {%
-    \makevalueexpandable
-    \def\temp{#2}%
-    \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
-    \ifx\temp\empty
-      \next{}%
-    \else
-      \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
-    \fi
-  }%
+  \def\temp{#2}%
+  \ifx\temp\empty \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname = \empty
+  \else \setzzz{#1}#2\endsetzzz % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
+  \fi
+  \endgroup
 }
-% Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
-\def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
+% Can't use \xdef to pre-expand #2 and save some time, since \temp or
+% \next or other control sequences that we've defined might get us into
+% an infinite loop. Consider ` set foo @cite{bar}'.
+\def\setzzz#1#2 \endsetzzz{\expandafter\gdef\csname SET#1\endcsname{#2}}
 
 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
 %
-\parseargdef\clear{%
-  {%
-    \makevalueexpandable
-    \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
-  }%
-}
+\def\clear{\parsearg\clearxxx}
+\def\clearxxx#1{\global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax}
 
 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
-\def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
-\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
 {
-  \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active
+  \catcode`\_ = \active
   %
-  \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
-    \let\value = \expandablevalue
-    % We don't want these characters active, ...
+  % We might end up with active _ or - characters in the argument if
+  % we're called from @code, as @code{ value{foo-bar_}}   So \let any
+  % such active characters to their normal equivalents.
+  \gdef\value{\begingroup
     \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
-    % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
-    % we're called from @code, as @code{ value{foo-bar_}}, though.
-    % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
-    \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
-  }
+    \indexbreaks \let_\normalunderscore
+    \valuexxx}
 }
+\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
 
 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
-% properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
-% The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
-% the result winds up in the index file.  This means that if the
-% variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
-% it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
-% to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
+% properly in indexes (we \let\value to this in \indexdummies).  Ones
+% whose names contain - or _ still won't work, but we can't do anything
+% about that.  The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable
+% is set), since the result winds up in the index file.  This means that
+% if the variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost
+% certain it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with
+% sufficient work to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of
+% complete).
 %
 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
   \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
@@ -3756,36 +2749,55 @@
 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
 % with @set.
 %
-% To get special treatment of ` end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
-%
-\makecond{ifset}
-\def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
-\def\doifset#1#2{%
-  {%
-    \makevalueexpandable
-    \let\next=\empty
-    \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
-      #1% If not set, redefine \next.
-    \fi
-    \expandafter
-  }\next
+\def\ifset{\parsearg\doifset}
+\def\doifset#1{%
+  \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
+    \let\next=\ifsetfail
+  \else
+    \let\next=\ifsetsucceed
+  \fi
+  \next
 }
+\def\ifsetsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifset}}
 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
+\defineunmatchedend{ifset}
 
 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
 %
-% The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
-% above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
-% then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
-%
-\makecond{ifclear}
-\def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
+\def\ifclear{\parsearg\doifclear}
+\def\doifclear#1{%
+  \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
+    \let\next=\ifclearsucceed
+  \else
+    \let\next=\ifclearfail
+  \fi
+  \next
+}
+\def\ifclearsucceed{\conditionalsucceed{ifclear}}
 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
+\defineunmatchedend{ifclear}
 
-% @dircategory CATEGORY  -- specify a category of the dir file
-% which this file should belong to.  Ignore this in TeX.
-\let\dircategory=\comment
+% @iftex, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext always succeed; we
+% read the text following, through the first @end iftex (etc.).  Make
+% ` end iftex' (etc.) valid only after an @iftex.
+%
+\def\iftex{\conditionalsucceed{iftex}}
+\def\ifnothtml{\conditionalsucceed{ifnothtml}}
+\def\ifnotinfo{\conditionalsucceed{ifnotinfo}}
+\def\ifnotplaintext{\conditionalsucceed{ifnotplaintext}}
+\defineunmatchedend{iftex}
+\defineunmatchedend{ifnothtml}
+\defineunmatchedend{ifnotinfo}
+\defineunmatchedend{ifnotplaintext}
+
+% True conditional.  Since \set globally defines its variables, we can
+% just start and end a group (to keep the @end definition undefined at
+% the outer level).
+%
+\def\conditionalsucceed#1{\begingroup
+  \expandafter\def\csname E#1\endcsname{\endgroup}%
+}
 
 % @defininfoenclose.
 \let\definfoenclose=\comment
@@ -3795,8 +2807,9 @@
 % Index generation facilities
 
 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
-% except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
-\edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
+% except not \outer, so it can be used within \newindex.
+{\catcode`\ =11
+\gdef\newwrite{\alloc 7\write\chardef\sixt@@n}}
 
 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that
@@ -3882,50 +2895,41 @@
 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
 %
 \def\indexdummies{%
-  \escapechar = `\\     % use backslash in output files.
   \def\ {@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
   \def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
-  %
   % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
   % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
   % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
   \let\{ = \mylbrace
   \let\} = \myrbrace
   %
-  % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
-  % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
-  % causes processing to be prematurely terminated.  This is,
-  % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
-  % is an expandable command.  The redefinition below makes \endinput
-  % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
-  % processing continues to some further point.  On the other hand, it
-  % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
-  % is still getting written without apparent harm.
-  % 
-  % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
-  % help-texinfo, 22may06):
-  % @macro funindex {WORD}
-  % @findex xyz
-  % @end macro
-  % ...
-  % @funindex commtest
-  % 
-  % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
-  % 
-  % Sample whatsit resulting:
-  %   write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{ code {xyz endinput }}}
-  % 
-  % So:
-  \let\endinput = \empty
+  % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \realbackslash #1\space, thus
+  % effectively preventing its expansion.  This is used only for control
+  % words, not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect
+  % for control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
+  % from whatever follows.
+  %
+  % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
+  % space.
+  %
+  % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
+  % those that do not.  If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
+  % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
+  %
+  \def\definedummyword##1{%
+    \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1\space}%
+  }%
+  \def\definedummyletter##1{%
+    \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1}%
+  }%
   %
   % Do the redefinitions.
   \commondummies
 }
 
-% For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character.  So we want to
-% redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
-% \realbackslash, still used for index files).  When everything uses @,
-% this will be simpler.
+% For the aux file, @ is the escape character.  So we want to redefine
+% everything using @ instead of \realbackslash.  When everything uses
+% @, this will be simpler.
 %
 \def\atdummies{%
   \def\ {@@}%
@@ -3933,190 +2937,161 @@
   \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd
   \let\} = \rbraceatcmd
   %
+  % (See comments in \indexdummies.)
+  \def\definedummyword##1{%
+    \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{ ##1\space}%
+  }%
+  \def\definedummyletter##1{%
+    \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{ ##1}%
+  }%
+  %
   % Do the redefinitions.
   \commondummies
-  \otherbackslash
 }
 
-% Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
+% Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.  \definedummyword and
+% \definedummyletter must be defined first.
 %
 \def\commondummies{%
   %
-  % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
-  % preventing its expansion.  This is used only for control% words,
-  % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
-  % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
-  % from whatever follows.
-  %
-  % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
-  % space.
-  %
-  % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
-  % those that do not.  If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
-  % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
+  \normalturnoffactive
   %
-  \def\definedummyword  ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}%
-  \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
-  \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
-  %
-  \commondummiesnofonts
-  %
-  \definedummyletter\_%
-  %
-  % Non-English letters.
-  \definedummyword\AA
-  \definedummyword\AE
-  \definedummyword\L
-  \definedummyword\OE
-  \definedummyword\O
-  \definedummyword\aa
-  \definedummyword\ae
-  \definedummyword\l
-  \definedummyword\oe
-  \definedummyword\o
-  \definedummyword\ss
-  \definedummyword\exclamdown
-  \definedummyword\questiondown
-  \definedummyword\ordf
-  \definedummyword\ordm
+  % Control letters and accents.
+  \definedummyletter{_}%
+  \definedummyletter{,}%
+  \definedummyletter{"}%
+  \definedummyletter{`}%
+  \definedummyletter{'}%
+  \definedummyletter{^}%
+  \definedummyletter{~}%
+  \definedummyletter{=}%
+  \definedummyword{u}%
+  \definedummyword{v}%
+  \definedummyword{H}%
+  \definedummyword{dotaccent}%
+  \definedummyword{ringaccent}%
+  \definedummyword{tieaccent}%
+  \definedummyword{ubaraccent}%
+  \definedummyword{udotaccent}%
+  \definedummyword{dotless}%
+  %
+  % Other non-English letters.
+  \definedummyword{AA}%
+  \definedummyword{AE}%
+  \definedummyword{L}%
+  \definedummyword{OE}%
+  \definedummyword{O}%
+  \definedummyword{aa}%
+  \definedummyword{ae}%
+  \definedummyword{l}%
+  \definedummyword{oe}%
+  \definedummyword{o}%
+  \definedummyword{ss}%
   %
   % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
-  \definedummyword\bf
-  \definedummyword\gtr
-  \definedummyword\hat
-  \definedummyword\less
-  \definedummyword\sf
-  \definedummyword\sl
-  \definedummyword\tclose
-  \definedummyword\tt
+  \definedummyword{bf}%
+  \definedummyword{gtr}%
+  \definedummyword{hat}%
+  \definedummyword{less}%
+  \definedummyword{sf}%
+  \definedummyword{sl}%
+  \definedummyword{tclose}%
+  \definedummyword{tt}%
   %
-  \definedummyword\LaTeX
-  \definedummyword\TeX
+  % Texinfo font commands.
+  \definedummyword{b}%
+  \definedummyword{i}%
+  \definedummyword{r}%
+  \definedummyword{sc}%
+  \definedummyword{t}%
+  %
+  \definedummyword{TeX}%
+  \definedummyword{acronym}%
+  \definedummyword{cite}%
+  \definedummyword{code}%
+  \definedummyword{command}%
+  \definedummyword{dfn}%
+  \definedummyword{dots}%
+  \definedummyword{emph}%
+  \definedummyword{env}%
+  \definedummyword{file}%
+  \definedummyword{kbd}%
+  \definedummyword{key}%
+  \definedummyword{math}%
+  \definedummyword{option}%
+  \definedummyword{samp}%
+  \definedummyword{strong}%
+  \definedummyword{uref}%
+  \definedummyword{url}%
+  \definedummyword{var}%
+  \definedummyword{verb}%
+  \definedummyword{w}%
   %
   % Assorted special characters.
-  \definedummyword\bullet
-  \definedummyword\comma
-  \definedummyword\copyright
-  \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
-  \definedummyword\dots
-  \definedummyword\enddots
-  \definedummyword\equiv
-  \definedummyword\error
-  \definedummyword\euro
-  \definedummyword\guillemetleft
-  \definedummyword\guillemetright
-  \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
-  \definedummyword\guilsinglright
-  \definedummyword\expansion
-  \definedummyword\minus
-  \definedummyword\pounds
-  \definedummyword\point
-  \definedummyword\print
-  \definedummyword\quotedblbase
-  \definedummyword\quotedblleft
-  \definedummyword\quotedblright
-  \definedummyword\quoteleft
-  \definedummyword\quoteright
-  \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
-  \definedummyword\result
-  \definedummyword\textdegree
+  \definedummyword{bullet}%
+  \definedummyword{copyright}%
+  \definedummyword{dots}%
+  \definedummyword{enddots}%
+  \definedummyword{equiv}%
+  \definedummyword{error}%
+  \definedummyword{expansion}%
+  \definedummyword{minus}%
+  \definedummyword{pounds}%
+  \definedummyword{point}%
+  \definedummyword{print}%
+  \definedummyword{result}%
   %
-  % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
-  \macrolist
+  % Handle some cases of @value -- where the variable name does not
+  % contain - or _, and the value does not contain any
+  % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
+  \let\value = \expandablevalue
   %
-  \normalturnoffactive
+  % Normal spaces, not active ones.
+  \unsepspaces
   %
-  % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
-  % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
-  \makevalueexpandable
+  % No macro expansion.
+  \turnoffmacros
 }
 
-% \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
-%
-\def\commondummiesnofonts{%
-  % Control letters and accents.
-  \definedummyletter\!%
-  \definedummyaccent\"%
-  \definedummyaccent\'%
-  \definedummyletter\*%
-  \definedummyaccent\,%
-  \definedummyletter\.%
-  \definedummyletter\/%
-  \definedummyletter\:%
-  \definedummyaccent\=%
-  \definedummyletter\?%
-  \definedummyaccent\^%
-  \definedummyaccent\`%
-  \definedummyaccent\~%
-  \definedummyword\u
-  \definedummyword\v
-  \definedummyword\H
-  \definedummyword\dotaccent
-  \definedummyword\ringaccent
-  \definedummyword\tieaccent
-  \definedummyword\ubaraccent
-  \definedummyword\udotaccent
-  \definedummyword\dotless
-  %
-  % Texinfo font commands.
-  \definedummyword\b
-  \definedummyword\i
-  \definedummyword\r
-  \definedummyword\sc
-  \definedummyword\t
-  %
-  % Commands that take arguments.
-  \definedummyword\acronym
-  \definedummyword\cite
-  \definedummyword\code
-  \definedummyword\command
-  \definedummyword\dfn
-  \definedummyword\emph
-  \definedummyword\env
-  \definedummyword\file
-  \definedummyword\kbd
-  \definedummyword\key
-  \definedummyword\math
-  \definedummyword\option
-  \definedummyword\pxref
-  \definedummyword\ref
-  \definedummyword\samp
-  \definedummyword\strong
-  \definedummyword\tie
-  \definedummyword\uref
-  \definedummyword\url
-  \definedummyword\var
-  \definedummyword\verb
-  \definedummyword\w
-  \definedummyword\xref
-}
+% If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
+% therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
+% expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \ M \ ).
+{\obeyspaces
+ \gdef\unsepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\space}}
+
 
 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
 % by, and when constructing control sequence names.  It eliminates all
 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
 %
+\def\indexdummytex{TeX}
+\def\indexdummydots{...}
+%
 \def\indexnofonts{%
-  % Accent commands should become @asis.
-  \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
-  % We can just ignore other control letters.
-  \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
-  % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
-  \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
-  %
-  \commondummiesnofonts
-  %
-  % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
-  % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
-  % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
-  %\let\tt=\asis
-  %
   \def\ { }%
   \def\ {@}%
   % how to handle braces?
   \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
   %
-  % Non-English letters.
+  \let\,=\asis
+  \let\"=\asis
+  \let\`=\asis
+  \let\'=\asis
+  \let\^=\asis
+  \let\~=\asis
+  \let\==\asis
+  \let\u=\asis
+  \let\v=\asis
+  \let\H=\asis
+  \let\dotaccent=\asis
+  \let\ringaccent=\asis
+  \let\tieaccent=\asis
+  \let\ubaraccent=\asis
+  \let\udotaccent=\asis
+  \let\dotless=\asis
+  %
+  % Other non-English letters.
   \def\AA{AA}%
   \def\AE{AE}%
   \def\L{L}%
@@ -4130,72 +3105,60 @@
   \def\ss{ss}%
   \def\exclamdown{!}%
   \def\questiondown{?}%
-  \def\ordf{a}%
-  \def\ordm{o}%
   %
-  \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
-  \def\TeX{TeX}%
+  % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
+  % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
+  % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
+  %\let\tt=\asis
   %
-  % Assorted special characters.
-  % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
-  \def\bullet{bullet}%
-  \def\comma{,}%
-  \def\copyright{copyright}%
-  \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
-  \def\dots{...}%
-  \def\enddots{...}%
-  \def\equiv{==}%
-  \def\error{error}%
-  \def\euro{euro}%
-  \def\guillemetleft{<<}%
-  \def\guillemetright{>>}%
-  \def\guilsinglleft{<}%
-  \def\guilsinglright{>}%
-  \def\expansion{==>}%
-  \def\minus{-}%
-  \def\pounds{pounds}%
-  \def\point{.}%
-  \def\print{-|}%
-  \def\quotedblbase{"}%
-  \def\quotedblleft{"}%
-  \def\quotedblright{"}%
-  \def\quoteleft{`}%
-  \def\quoteright{'}%
-  \def\quotesinglbase{,}%
-  \def\result{=>}%
-  \def\textdegree{degrees}%
-  %
-  % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
-  % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
-  % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
-  % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
-  % that starts with \.
-  % 
-  % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
-  % to take a single TeX argument.  The case of a macro invocation that
-  % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
-  % 
-  \macrolist
+  % Texinfo font commands.
+  \let\b=\asis
+  \let\i=\asis
+  \let\r=\asis
+  \let\sc=\asis
+  \let\t=\asis
+  %
+  \let\TeX=\indexdummytex
+  \let\acronym=\asis
+  \let\cite=\asis
+  \let\code=\asis
+  \let\command=\asis
+  \let\dfn=\asis
+  \let\dots=\indexdummydots
+  \let\emph=\asis
+  \let\env=\asis
+  \let\file=\asis
+  \let\kbd=\asis
+  \let\key=\asis
+  \let\math=\asis
+  \let\option=\asis
+  \let\samp=\asis
+  \let\strong=\asis
+  \let\uref=\asis
+  \let\url=\asis
+  \let\var=\asis
+  \let\verb=\asis
+  \let\w=\asis
 }
 
 \let\indexbackslash=0  %overridden during \printindex.
 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
 
 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
-% #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
+%
 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
 
 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
-% empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
-% is with most defuns, which call us directly).
+% \empty if called from \doind, as we usually are.  The main exception
+% is with defuns, which call us directly.
 %
 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
   \iflinks
   {%
     % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
     \toks0 = {#2}%
-    % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
+    % If third arg is present, precede it with space.
     \def\thirdarg{#3}%
     \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
       \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
@@ -4203,12 +3166,16 @@
     %
     \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
     %
-    \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
+    \ifvmode
+      \dosubindsanitize
+    \else
+      \dosubindwrite
+    \fi
   }%
   \fi
 }
 
-% Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
+% Write the entry to the index file:
 %
 \def\dosubindwrite{%
   % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
@@ -4218,7 +3185,8 @@
   %
   % Remember, we are within a group.
   \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
-  \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
+  \escapechar=`\\
+  \def\rawbackslashxx{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
       % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
   %
   % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
@@ -4240,13 +3208,13 @@
   \temp
 }
 
-% Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
+%  Take care of unwanted page breaks:
 %
 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
 % the skip again.  Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
-% \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero.  The result is that
-% sequences like this:
+% \write will make \lastskip zero.  The result is that sequences
+% like this:
 % @end defun
 % @tindex whatever
 % @defun ...
@@ -4259,63 +3227,38 @@
 %
 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
 %
-% But wait, there is a catch there:
-% We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip.  \ifdim is not
-% sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
-% of the skip.  The only way seems to be to check the textual
-% representation of the skip.
-%
-% The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
-% the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
-%
-\edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z skip\endcsname}
-%
-\newskip\whatsitskip
-\newcount\whatsitpenalty
-%
-% ..., ready, GO:
-%
-\def\safewhatsit#1{%
-\ifhmode
-  #1%
-\else
+\def\dosubindsanitize{%
   % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
-  \whatsitskip = \lastskip
-  \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
-  \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
+  \skip0 = \lastskip
+  \count255 = \lastpenalty
   %
   % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
   % skip.  And since a skip is discardable, that means this
-  % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
+  % -\skip0 glue we're inserting is preceded by a
   % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
   % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
-  \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
-  \else
-    \vskip-\whatsitskip
-  \fi
+  \ifdim\lastskip = 0pt \else \vskip-\skip0 \fi
   %
-  #1%
+  \dosubindwrite
   %
-  \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
-    % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
-    % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak.  In that case, we want
-    % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
-    % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
-    % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint.  For example:
-    % 
+  \ifdim\skip0 = 0pt
+    % if \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a
+    % penalty, and perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak.
+    % In that case, we want to re-insert the penalty; since we
+    % just inserted a non-discardable item, any following glue
+    % (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint.  For example:
     %   @deffn deffn-whatever
     %   @vindex index-whatever
     %   Description.
     % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
     % and the "Description." paragraph.
-    \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
+    \ifnum\count255>9999 \nobreak \fi
   \else
     % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
     % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
     % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
-    \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
+    \nobreak\vskip\skip0
   \fi
-\fi
 }
 
 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
@@ -4353,13 +3296,14 @@
 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
 %
-\parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
+\def\printindex{\parsearg\doprintindex}
+\def\doprintindex#1{\begingroup
   \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
   %
   \smallfonts \rm
   \tolerance = 9500
-  \plainfrenchspacing
   \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
+  \indexbreaks
   %
   % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
   % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
@@ -4386,7 +3330,7 @@
       % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
       % character.  It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
       % to make right now.
-      \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
+      \def\indexbackslash{\rawbackslashxx}%
       \catcode`\\ = 0
       \escapechar = `\\
       \begindoublecolumns
@@ -4408,10 +3352,7 @@
   \removelastskip
   %
   % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
-  \nobreak
-  \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
-  \penalty 0
-  \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
+  \penalty -300
   %
   % Typeset the initial.  Making this add up to a whole number of
   % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
@@ -4421,101 +3362,84 @@
   % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
   \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
   \leftline{\secbf #1}%
+  \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
+  %
   % Do our best not to break after the initial.
   \nobreak
-  \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
 }}
 
-% \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
-% then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin.  It is used for index
-% and table of contents entries.  The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
-%
-% A straightforward implementation would start like this:
-%	\def\entry#1#2{...
-% But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
-% @code, which sets - active.  This problem was fixed by a kludge---
-% ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
-%
-% The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
-%                                 --kasal, 21nov03
-\def\entry{%
-  \begingroup
-    %
-    % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
-    % affect previous text.
-    \par
-    %
-    % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
-    \parfillskip = 0in
-    %
-    % No extra space above this paragraph.
-    \parskip = 0in
-    %
-    % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
-    \finalhyphendemerits = 0
-    %
-    % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
-    % don't both fit on one line.  In that case, bob suggests starting the
-    % dots pretty far over on the line.  Unfortunately, a large
-    % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
-    % lines.  So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
-    %
-    % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
-    % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
-    \hangindent = 2em
-    %
-    % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
-    % with blank space.
-    \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
-    %
-    % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
-    % columns.
-    \vskip 0pt plus1pt
-    %
-    % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
-    \afterassignment\doentry
-    \let\temp =
-}
-\def\doentry{%
-    \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
-      \noindent
-      \aftergroup\finishentry
-      % And now comes the text of the entry.
-}
-\def\finishentry#1{%
-    % #1 is the page number.
-    %
-    % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
-    % there are no page numbers.  The next person who breaks this will be
-    % cursed by a Unix daemon.
-    \setbox\boxA = \hbox{#1}%
-    \ifdim\wd\boxA = 0pt
-      \ %
+% This typesets a paragraph consisting of #1, dot leaders, and then #2
+% flush to the right margin.  It is used for index and table of contents
+% entries.  The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
+%
+\def\entry#1#2{\begingroup
+  %
+  % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
+  % affect previous text.
+  \par
+  %
+  % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
+  \parfillskip = 0in
+  %
+  % No extra space above this paragraph.
+  \parskip = 0in
+  %
+  % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
+  \finalhyphendemerits = 0
+  %
+  % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
+  % don't both fit on one line.  In that case, bob suggests starting the
+  % dots pretty far over on the line.  Unfortunately, a large
+  % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
+  % lines.  So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
+  %
+  % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
+  % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
+  \hangindent = 2em
+  %
+  % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
+  % with blank space.
+  \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
+  %
+  % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing columns.
+  \vskip 0pt plus1pt
+  %
+  % Start a ``paragraph'' for the index entry so the line breaking
+  % parameters we've set above will have an effect.
+  \noindent
+  %
+  % Insert the text of the index entry.  TeX will do line-breaking on it.
+  #1%
+  % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
+  % there are no page numbers.  The next person who breaks this will be
+  % cursed by a Unix daemon.
+  \def\tempa{{\rm }}%
+  \def\tempb{#2}%
+  \edef\tempc{\tempa}%
+  \edef\tempd{\tempb}%
+  \ifx\tempc\tempd\ \else%
+    %
+    % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
+    % this line with blank space.  (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
+    % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
+    \hfil\penalty50
+    \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
+    %
+    % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
+    % part of (the primitive) \par.  Without it, a spurious underfull
+    % \hbox ensues.
+    \ifpdf
+      \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
     \else
-      %
-      % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
-      % this line with blank space.  (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
-      % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
-      \hfil\penalty50
-      \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
-      %
-      % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
-      % part of (the primitive) \par.  Without it, a spurious underfull
-      % \hbox ensues.
-      \ifpdf
-	\pdfgettoks#1.%
-	\ \the\toksA
-      \else
-	\ #1%
-      \fi
+      \ #2% The page number ends the paragraph.
     \fi
-    \par
-  \endgroup
-}
+  \fi%
+  \par
+\endgroup}
 
-% Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
+% Like \dotfill except takes at least 1 em.
 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
-  \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
+  \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu ${\it .}$ \mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
 
 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
 
@@ -4625,34 +3549,6 @@
 %
 % All done with double columns.
 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
-  % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
-  % _before_ we change the output routine.  This is necessary in the
-  % following situation:
-  %
-  % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
-  % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
-  % break occurs before the last section starts.  However, the last
-  % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
-  % fit on the page and has to be broken off.  Without the following
-  % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
-  % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
-  % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
-  % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
-  % is wrong:  The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
-  % the broken-off section in the recent contributions.  As soon as
-  % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
-  % break.  The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
-  % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
-  % goal.  When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
-  % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
-  % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
-  % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
-  % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
-  %
-  % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
-  % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
-  \penalty0
-  %
   \output = {%
     % Split the last of the double-column material.  Leave it on the
     % current page, no automatic page break.
@@ -4726,7 +3622,7 @@
 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
-%
+% 
 \def\appendixletter{%
   \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
   \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
@@ -4762,15 +3658,11 @@
   \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
   \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
 
-% Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
-% and name of the chapter.  Page headings and footings can use
-% these.  @section does likewise.
+% Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter.
+% page headings and footings can use it.  @section does likewise.
+% However, they are not reliable, because we don't use marks.
 \def\thischapter{}
-\def\thischapternum{}
-\def\thischaptername{}
 \def\thissection{}
-\def\thissectionnum{}
-\def\thissectionname{}
 
 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
@@ -4783,106 +3675,59 @@
 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
 
-% we only have subsub.
-\chardef\maxseclevel = 3
-%
-% A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
-% To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
-\chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel
-%
-% Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
-% \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
-\def\chapheadtype{N}
-
-% Choose a heading macro
-% #1 is heading type
-% #2 is heading level
-% #3 is text for heading
-\def\genhead#1#2#3{%
-  % Compute the abs. sec. level:
-  \absseclevel=#2
-  \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
-  % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
-  \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
-    \absseclevel = 0
+% Choose a numbered-heading macro
+% #1 is heading level if unmodified by @raisesections or @lowersections
+% #2 is text for heading
+\def\numhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1
+\ifcase\absseclevel
+      \chapterzzz{#2}%
+  \or \seczzz{#2}%
+  \or \numberedsubseczzz{#2}%
+  \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2}%
   \else
-    \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
-      \absseclevel = 3
+    \ifnum \absseclevel<0 \chapterzzz{#2}%
+    \else \numberedsubsubseczzz{#2}%
     \fi
   \fi
-  % The heading type:
-  \def\headtype{#1}%
-  \if \headtype U%
-    \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel
-      \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel
-    \fi
+  \suppressfirstparagraphindent
+}
+
+% like \numhead, but chooses appendix heading levels
+\def\apphead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1
+\ifcase\absseclevel
+      \appendixzzz{#2}%
+  \or \appendixsectionzzz{#2}%
+  \or \appendixsubseczzz{#2}%
+  \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2}%
   \else
-    % Check for appendix sections:
-    \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
-      \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
-    \else
-      \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
-	\errmessage{ appendix    within a non-appendix chapter}%
-      \fi\fi
-    \fi
-    % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
-    \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel
-      \def\headtype{U}%
-    \else
-      \chardef\unmlevel = 3
+    \ifnum \absseclevel<0 \appendixzzz{#2}%
+    \else \appendixsubsubseczzz{#2}%
     \fi
   \fi
-  % Now print the heading:
-  \if \headtype U%
-    \ifcase\absseclevel
-	\unnumberedzzz{#3}%
-    \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
-    \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
-    \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
-    \fi
+  \suppressfirstparagraphindent
+}
+
+% like \numhead, but chooses numberless heading levels
+\def\unnmhead#1#2{\absseclevel=\secbase\advance\absseclevel by #1
+  \ifcase\absseclevel
+      \unnumberedzzz{#2}%
+  \or \unnumberedseczzz{#2}%
+  \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#2}%
+  \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2}%
   \else
-    \if \headtype A%
-      \ifcase\absseclevel
-	  \appendixzzz{#3}%
-      \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
-      \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
-      \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
-      \fi
-    \else
-      \ifcase\absseclevel
-	  \chapterzzz{#3}%
-      \or \seczzz{#3}%
-      \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
-      \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
-      \fi
+    \ifnum \absseclevel<0 \unnumberedzzz{#2}%
+    \else \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#2}%
     \fi
   \fi
   \suppressfirstparagraphindent
 }
 
-% an interface:
-\def\numhead{\genhead N}
-\def\apphead{\genhead A}
-\def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
-
-% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered.  Increment top-level counter, reset
-% all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
-%
-% Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
-% (e.g., figures), q.v.  By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
-\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
+% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered.
 %
-\outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
+\outer\def\chapter{\parsearg\chapteryyy}
+\def\chapteryyy#1{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
 \def\chapterzzz#1{%
-  % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
-  % as an @include file.
-  \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
-    \global\advance\chapno by 1
-  %
-  % Used for \float.
-  \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
-  \resetallfloatnos
-  %
+  \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0  \advance\chapno by 1
   \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
   %
   % Write the actual heading.
@@ -4894,31 +3739,29 @@
   \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
 }
 
-\outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
+\outer\def\appendix{\parsearg\appendixyyy}
+\def\appendixyyy#1{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
-  \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
-    \global\advance\appendixno by 1
-  \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
-  \resetallfloatnos
-  %
+  \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0  \advance\appendixno by 1
   \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
   \message{\appendixnum}%
-  %
   \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
-  %
   \global\let\section = \appendixsec
   \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
   \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
 }
 
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
+% @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
+\outer\def\centerchap{\parsearg\centerchapyyy}
+\def\centerchapyyy#1{{\unnumberedyyy{#1}}}
+
+% @top is like @unnumbered.
+\outer\def\top{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy}
+
+\outer\def\unnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedyyy}
+\def\unnumberedyyy#1{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
-  \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
-    \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
-  %
-  % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
-  \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
-  \resetallfloatnos
+  \secno=0 \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0  \advance\unnumberedno by 1
   %
   % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
   % argument to \message.  Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
@@ -4931,8 +3774,7 @@
   % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
   % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>.  (We also do this for
   % the toc entries.)
-  \toks0 = {#1}%
-  \message{(\the\toks0)}%
+  \toks0 = {#1}\message{(\the\toks0)}%
   %
   \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
   %
@@ -4941,82 +3783,96 @@
   \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
 }
 
-% @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
-\outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
-  % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
-  % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
-  % Thus we are safer this way:		--kasal, 24feb04
-  \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
-  \unnmhead0{#1}%
-  \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
-}
-
-% @top is like @unnumbered.
-\let\top\unnumbered
-
 % Sections.
-\outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
+\outer\def\numberedsec{\parsearg\secyyy}
+\def\secyyy#1{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
 \def\seczzz#1{%
-  \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\secno by 1
+  \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0  \advance\secno by 1
   \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
 }
 
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
+\outer\def\appendixsection{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy}
+\outer\def\appendixsec{\parsearg\appendixsecyyy}
+\def\appendixsecyyy#1{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
-  \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\secno by 1
+  \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0  \advance\secno by 1
   \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
 }
-\let\appendixsec\appendixsection
 
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
+\outer\def\unnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsecyyy}
+\def\unnumberedsecyyy#1{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
-  \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\secno by 1
+  \subsecno=0 \subsubsecno=0  \advance\secno by 1
   \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
 }
 
 % Subsections.
-\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
+\outer\def\numberedsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsecyyy}
+\def\numberedsubsecyyy#1{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
-  \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\subsecno by 1
+  \subsubsecno=0  \advance\subsecno by 1
   \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
 }
 
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
+\outer\def\appendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsecyyy}
+\def\appendixsubsecyyy#1{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
-  \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\subsecno by 1
+  \subsubsecno=0  \advance\subsecno by 1
   \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
                  {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
 }
 
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
+\outer\def\unnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsecyyy}
+\def\unnumberedsubsecyyy#1{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
-  \global\subsubsecno=0  \global\advance\subsecno by 1
+  \subsubsecno=0  \advance\subsecno by 1
   \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
                  {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
 }
 
 % Subsubsections.
-\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
+\outer\def\numberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\numberedsubsubsecyyy}
+\def\numberedsubsubsecyyy#1{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
-  \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
+  \advance\subsubsecno by 1
   \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
                  {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
 }
 
-\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
+\outer\def\appendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubsecyyy}
+\def\appendixsubsubsecyyy#1{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
-  \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
+  \advance\subsubsecno by 1
   \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
                  {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
 }
 
-\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
+\outer\def\unnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy}
+\def\unnumberedsubsubsecyyy#1{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
-  \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
+  \advance\subsubsecno by 1
   \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
                  {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
 }
 
+% These are variants which are not "outer", so they can appear in @ifinfo.
+% Actually, they are now be obsolete; ordinary section commands should work.
+\def\infotop{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz}
+\def\infounnumbered{\parsearg\unnumberedzzz}
+\def\infounnumberedsec{\parsearg\unnumberedseczzz}
+\def\infounnumberedsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubseczzz}
+\def\infounnumberedsubsubsec{\parsearg\unnumberedsubsubseczzz}
+
+\def\infoappendix{\parsearg\appendixzzz}
+\def\infoappendixsec{\parsearg\appendixseczzz}
+\def\infoappendixsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubseczzz}
+\def\infoappendixsubsubsec{\parsearg\appendixsubsubseczzz}
+
+\def\infochapter{\parsearg\chapterzzz}
+\def\infosection{\parsearg\sectionzzz}
+\def\infosubsection{\parsearg\subsectionzzz}
+\def\infosubsubsection{\parsearg\subsubsectionzzz}
+
 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
@@ -5050,11 +3906,14 @@
 }
 
 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
-\parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
+\def\heading{\parsearg\doheading}
+\def\subheading{\parsearg\dosubheading}
+\def\subsubheading{\parsearg\dosubsubheading}
+\def\doheading#1{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
   \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
-\parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
+\def\dosubheading#1{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
   \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
-\parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
+\def\dosubsubheading#1{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
   \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
 
 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
@@ -5064,6 +3923,8 @@
 %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
 
+\def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
+
 %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
 
@@ -5071,20 +3932,7 @@
 
 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
-% Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
-% get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong.  But we don't
-% care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
-\def\chapoddpage{%
-  \chappager
-  \ifodd\pageno \else
-    \begingroup
-      \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}%
-      \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}%
-      \hbox to 0pt{}%
-      \chappager
-    \endgroup
-  \fi
-}
+\def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi}
 
 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
 
@@ -5107,83 +3955,57 @@
 
 \CHAPPAGon
 
-% Chapter opening.
-%
+\def\CHAPFplain{%
+\global\let\chapmacro=\chfplain
+\global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfplain}
+
+% Normal chapter opening.
+% 
 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
-%
+% 
 % To test against our argument.
 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
 %
-\def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
-  % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
-  \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
-  \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
-  \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
-                        \gdef\thissection{}}%
-  %
-  \def\temptype{#2}%
-  \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
-    \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
-                          \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
-  \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
-    \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
-                          \gdef\thischapter{}}%
-  \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
-    \toks0={#1}%
-    \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
-      \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
-      \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
-      \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \noexpand\thischapternum:
-                                 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
-    }%
-  \else
-    \toks0={#1}%
-    \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
-      \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
-      \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
-      \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \noexpand\thischapternum:
-                                 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
-    }%
-  \fi\fi\fi
-  %
-  % Output the mark.  Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
-  % the preceding space.
-  \safewhatsit\domark
-  %
-  % Insert the chapter heading break.
+\def\chfplain#1#2#3{%
   \pchapsepmacro
-  %
-  % Now the second mark, after the heading break.  No break points
-  % between here and the heading.
-  \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
-  \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
-  \domark
-  %
   {%
     \chapfonts \rm
     %
-    % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
-    % xref code eventually uses it.  On the other hand, it has to be called
-    % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
-    \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
+    % Have to define \thissection before calling \donoderef, because the
+    % xref code eventually uses it, as \Ytitle.  On the other hand, it
+    % has to be called after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change
+    % too soon.
+    \gdef\thissection{#1}%
+    \gdef\thischaptername{#1}%
     %
     % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
     % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
+    \def\temptype{#2}%
     \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
       \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
       \def\toctype{unnchap}%
+      \def\thischapter{#1}%
     \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
       \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
       \def\toctype{omit}%
+      \xdef\thischapter{}%
     \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
       \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
       \def\toctype{app}%
+      % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter
+      % because we don't want its macros evaluated now.  And we don't
+      % use \thissection because that changes with each section.
+      %
+      \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter:
+                        \noexpand\thischaptername}%
     \else
       \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
       \def\toctype{numchap}%
+      \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno:
+                        \noexpand\thischaptername}%
     \fi\fi\fi
     %
     % Write the toc entry for this chapter.  Must come before the
@@ -5199,7 +4021,6 @@
     \donoderef{#2}%
     %
     % Typeset the actual heading.
-    \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
     \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
           \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
           \unhbox0 #1\par}%
@@ -5210,40 +4031,45 @@
 
 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
-\def\centerparameters{%
-  \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
-  \leftskip = \rightskip
-  \parfillskip = 0pt
-}
+\def\centerchfplain#1{{%
+  \def\centerparametersmaybe{%
+    \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
+    \leftskip = \rightskip
+    \parfillskip = 0pt
+  }%
+  \chfplain{#1}{Ynothing}{}%
+}}
 
+\CHAPFplain % The default
 
 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
 % updating it with the new noderef stuff.  We'll see.  --karl, 11aug03.
-%
-\def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
-%
+% 
 \def\unnchfopen #1{%
 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
                        \parindent=0pt\raggedright
                        \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
 }
+
 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
 \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
 \par\penalty 5000 %
 }
+
 \def\centerchfopen #1{%
 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
                        \parindent=0pt
                        \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
 }
+
 \def\CHAPFopen{%
-  \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
-  \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
+\global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
+\global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
 
 
 % Section titles.  These macros combine the section number parts and
 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
-%
+% 
 \newskip\secheadingskip
 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
 
@@ -5257,100 +4083,50 @@
 
 
 % Print any size, any type, section title.
-%
+% 
 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
 % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
 % section number.
-%
-\def\seckeyword{sec}
-%
+% 
 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
   {%
     % Switch to the right set of fonts.
     \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
     %
-    \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
-    \def\temptype{#3}%
-    %
-    % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
-    \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
-    \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
-      \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
-        \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
-                              \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
-      \fi
-    \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
-      % Don't redefine \thissection.
-    \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
-      \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
-        \toks0={#1}%
-        \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
-          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
-          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
-          \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\putwordSection{} \noexpand\thissectionnum:
-                                     \noexpand\thissectionname}%
-        }%
-      \fi
-    \else
-      \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
-        \toks0={#1}%
-        \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
-          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
-          \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
-          \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\putwordSection{} \noexpand\thissectionnum:
-                                     \noexpand\thissectionname}%
-        }%
-      \fi
-    \fi\fi\fi
-    %
-    % Output the mark.  Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
-    % the preceding space.
-    \safewhatsit\domark
-    %
     % Insert space above the heading.
     \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
     %
-    % Now the second mark, after the heading break.  No break points
-    % between here and the heading.
-    \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
-    \domark
-    %
     % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
+    \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
+    \def\temptype{#3}%
+    %
     \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
       \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
       \def\toctype{unn}%
-      \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
+      \gdef\thissection{#1}%
     \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
       % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
-      % and don't redefine \lastsection.
+      % and don't redefine \thissection.
       \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
       \def\toctype{omit}%
       \let\sectionlevel=\empty
     \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
       \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
       \def\toctype{app}%
-      \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
+      \gdef\thissection{#1}%
     \else
       \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
       \def\toctype{num}%
-      \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
+      \gdef\thissection{#1}%
     \fi\fi\fi
     %
-    % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef).  See comments in \chapmacro.
+    % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef).  See comments in \chfplain.
     \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
     %
     % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
-    % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
+    % Again, see comments in \chfplain.
     \donoderef{#3}%
     %
-    % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
-    % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
-    % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
-    % \writetocentry if there was no node).  We don't want to allow that
-    % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
-    % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong.  Debian bug 276000.
-    \nobreak
-    %
     % Output the actual section heading.
     \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
           \hangindent=\wd0  % zero if no section number
@@ -5368,14 +4144,14 @@
   % glue accumulate.  (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
   % discardable item.)
   \vskip-\parskip
-  % 
-  % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
-  % 10000.  This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
-  % section headings.  Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
-  % 
+  %
+  % This \nobreak is purely so the last item on the list is a \penalty
+  % of 10000.  This is so other code, for instance \parsebodycommon, can
+  % check for and avoid allowing breakpoints.  Otherwise, it would
+  % insert a valid breakpoint between:
   %   @section sec-whatever
   %   @deffn def-whatever
-  \penalty 10001
+  \nobreak
 }
 
 
@@ -5384,14 +4160,14 @@
 \newwrite\tocfile
 
 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
-% Called from @chapter, etc.
-%
+% Called from @chapter, etc.  
+% 
 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
 % read this.  The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
 % destination to jump to.
-%
+% 
 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything.  This is used for the
@@ -5409,11 +4185,11 @@
     \fi
     %
     \iflinks
-      {\atdummies
-       \edef\temp{%
-         \write\tocfile{ #1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
-       \temp
-      }%
+      \toks0 = {#2}%
+      \toks2 = \expandafter{\lastnode}%
+      \edef\temp{\write\tocfile{\realbackslash #1entry{\the\toks0}{#3}%
+                               {\the\toks2}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+      \temp
     \fi
   \fi
   %
@@ -5426,31 +4202,6 @@
   \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
 }
 
-
-% These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
-% fonts, so we must take special care.  This is more or less redundant
-% with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
-% 
-\def\activecatcodes{%
-  \catcode`\"=\active
-  \catcode`\$=\active
-  \catcode`\<=\active
-  \catcode`\>=\active
-  \catcode`\\=\active
-  \catcode`\^=\active
-  \catcode`\_=\active
-  \catcode`\|=\active
-  \catcode`\~=\active
-}
-
-
-% Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
-\def\readtocfile{%
-  \setupdatafile
-  \activecatcodes
-  \input \tocreadfilename
-}
-
 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
 \newcount\savepageno
 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
@@ -5458,83 +4209,81 @@
 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
 %
 \def\startcontents#1{%
-  % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
-  % start on an odd page, unlike chapters.  Thus, we maintain
-  % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
-  % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege matematik su se>
-  \contentsalignmacro
-  \immediate\closeout\tocfile
-  %
-  % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
-  % It is abundantly clear what they are.
-  \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
-  %
-  \savepageno = \pageno
-  \begingroup                  % Set up to handle contents files properly.
-    \raggedbottom              % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
-    \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
-    %
-    % Roman numerals for page numbers.
-    \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
+   % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
+   % start on an odd page, unlike chapters.  Thus, we maintain
+   % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
+   % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege matematik su se>
+   \contentsalignmacro
+   \immediate\closeout\tocfile
+   %
+   % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
+   % It is abundantly clear what they are.
+   \def\thischapter{}%
+   \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
+   %
+   \savepageno = \pageno
+   \begingroup                  % Set up to handle contents files properly.
+      \catcode`\\=0  \catcode`\{=1  \catcode`\}=2  \catcode`\ =11
+      % We can't do this, because then an actual ^ in a section
+      % title fails, e.g., @chapter ^ -- exponentiation.  --karl, 9jul97.
+      %\catcode`\^=7 % to see ^^e4 as \"a etc. juha piuha ydi vtt fi
+      \raggedbottom             % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
+      \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
+      %
+      % Roman numerals for page numbers.
+      \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
 }
 
-% redefined for the two-volume lispref.  We always output on
-% \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
-% 
-\def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
 
 % Normal (long) toc.
-%
 \def\contents{%
-  \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
-    \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
-    \ifeof 1 \else
-      \readtocfile
-    \fi
-    \vfill \eject
-    \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
-    \ifeof 1 \else
-      \pdfmakeoutlines
-    \fi
-    \closein 1
-  \endgroup
-  \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
-  \global\pageno = \savepageno
+   \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
+     \openin 1 \jobname.toc
+     \ifeof 1 \else
+       \closein 1
+       \input \jobname.toc
+     \fi
+     \vfill \eject
+     \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
+     \pdfmakeoutlines
+   \endgroup
+   \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
+   \global\pageno = \savepageno
 }
 
 % And just the chapters.
 \def\summarycontents{%
-  \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
-    %
-    \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
-    \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
-    \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
-    % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
-    \secfonts
-    \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
-    \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
-    \rm
-    \hyphenpenalty = 10000
-    \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
-    \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
-    \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
-    \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
-    \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
-    \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
-    \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
-    \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
-    \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
-    \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
-    \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
-    \ifeof 1 \else
-      \readtocfile
-    \fi
-    \closein 1
-    \vfill \eject
-    \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
-  \endgroup
-  \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
-  \global\pageno = \savepageno
+   \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
+      %
+      \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
+      \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
+      \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
+      % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
+      \secfonts
+      \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
+      \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
+      \rm
+      \hyphenpenalty = 10000
+      \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
+      \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
+      \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
+      \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
+      \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+      \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+      \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+      \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+      \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+      \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+      \openin 1 \jobname.toc
+      \ifeof 1 \else
+        \closein 1
+        \input \jobname.toc
+      \fi
+     \vfill \eject
+     \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
+   \endgroup
+   \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
+   \global\pageno = \savepageno
 }
 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
 
@@ -5547,7 +4296,7 @@
   % But use \hss just in case.
   % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
   % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
-  %
+  % 
   % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
   % with appendix letters.  And right-justifying numbers and
   % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
@@ -5572,7 +4321,7 @@
 
 % Appendices, in the main contents.
 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
-%
+% 
 \def\appendixbox#1{%
   % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
   \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
@@ -5600,8 +4349,7 @@
 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
 
 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
-% Same as \defaultparindent.
-\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
+\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 2pc
 
 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
 % page number.
@@ -5632,8 +4380,17 @@
   \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
 \endgroup}
 
-% We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
-\let\tocentry = \entry
+% Final typesetting of a toc entry; we use the same \entry macro as for
+% the index entries, but we want to suppress hyphenation here.  (We
+% can't do that in the \entry macro, since index entries might consist
+% of hyphenated-identifiers-that-do-not-fit-on-a-line-and-nothing-else.)
+\def\tocentry#1#2{\begingroup
+  \vskip 0pt plus1pt % allow a little stretch for the sake of nice page breaks
+  % Do not use \turnoffactive in these arguments.  Since the toc is
+  % typeset in cmr, characters such as _ would come out wrong; we
+  % have to do the usual translation tricks.
+  \entry{#1}{#2}%
+\endgroup}
 
 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
@@ -5669,12 +4426,12 @@
 {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
-\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf error\kern-1.5pt}
+\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt}
 %
-\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
+\global\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
    \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
    \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
-   \vbox{%
+   \vbox{
       \hrule height\dimen2
       \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt          % Space to left of text.
          \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
@@ -5688,13 +4445,14 @@
 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
 
-\envdef\tex{%
+\def\tex{\begingroup
   \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
   \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
   \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
   \catcode `\%=14
   \catcode `\+=\other
   \catcode `\"=\other
+  \catcode `\==\other
   \catcode `\|=\other
   \catcode `\<=\other
   \catcode `\>=\other
@@ -5717,16 +4475,14 @@
   \let\/=\ptexslash
   \let\*=\ptexstar
   \let\t=\ptext
-  \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
   %
   \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
   \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
   \def\ {@}%
-}
-% There is no need to define \Etex.
+\let\Etex=\endgroup}
 
 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
-% @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
+% @lisp does a \begingroup so it can rebind things,
 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
 
 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
@@ -5737,6 +4493,19 @@
 % have any width.
 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
 
+% Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
+% space in the output.  Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
+% is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
+% should produce a line of output anyway.
+%
+{\obeyspaces %
+\gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}}
+
+% Define \obeyedspace to be our active space, whatever it is.  This is
+% for use in \parsearg.
+{\sepspaces%
+\global\let\obeyedspace= }
+
 % This space is always present above and below environments.
 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
 
@@ -5746,8 +4515,7 @@
 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
 %
 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
-  % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
-  % \sectionheading, q.v.
+  % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz, q.v.
   \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
     \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
     \endgraf
@@ -5755,7 +4523,7 @@
       \removelastskip
       % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
       % or better ...
-      \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
+      \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \else \penalty-50 \fi
       \vskip\envskipamount
     \fi
   \fi
@@ -5763,8 +4531,7 @@
 
 \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
 
-% \nonarrowing is a flag.  If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
-% also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
+% \nonarrowing is a flag.  If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins.
 \let\nonarrowing=\relax
 
 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
@@ -5788,52 +4555,52 @@
 %
 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
 
-\envdef\cartouche{%
-  \ifhmode\par\fi  % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
-  \startsavinginserts
-  \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
-  \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
-  \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
-  \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
-  \cartouter=\hsize
-  \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt	% allow for 3pt kerns on either
-				% side, and for 6pt waste from
-				% each corner char, and rule thickness
-  \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
-  % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
-  \let\nonarrowing = t%
-  \vbox\bgroup
-      \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
-      \carttop
-      \hbox\bgroup
-	  \hskip\lskip
-	  \vrule\kern3pt
-	  \vbox\bgroup
-	      \kern3pt
-	      \hsize=\cartinner
-	      \baselineskip=\normbskip
-	      \lineskip=\normlskip
-	      \parskip=\normpskip
-	      \vskip -\parskip
-	      \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
-}
+\def\cartouche{%
+\par  % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
+\begingroup
+        \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
+        \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt %we want these *outside*.
+        \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
+                          \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
+        \cartouter=\hsize
+        \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
+%                                    side, and for 6pt waste from
+%                                    each corner char, and rule thickness
+        \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
+        % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
+        \let\nonarrowing=\comment
+        \vbox\bgroup
+                \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
+                \carttop
+                \hbox\bgroup
+                        \hskip\lskip
+                        \vrule\kern3pt
+                        \vbox\bgroup
+                                \hsize=\cartinner
+                                \kern3pt
+                                \begingroup
+                                        \baselineskip=\normbskip
+                                        \lineskip=\normlskip
+                                        \parskip=\normpskip
+                                        \vskip -\parskip
 \def\Ecartouche{%
-              \ifhmode\par\fi
-	      \kern3pt
-	  \egroup
-	  \kern3pt\vrule
-	  \hskip\rskip
-      \egroup
-      \cartbot
-  \egroup
-  \checkinserts
-}
+                                \endgroup
+                                \kern3pt
+                        \egroup
+                        \kern3pt\vrule
+                        \hskip\rskip
+                \egroup
+                \cartbot
+        \egroup
+\endgroup
+}}
 
 
 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
 % inside a group.
 \def\nonfillstart{%
   \aboveenvbreak
+  \inENV % This group ends at the end of the body
   \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy
   \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
   \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
@@ -5841,139 +4608,116 @@
   \parskip = 0pt
   \parindent = 0pt
   \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
+  % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing
+  % at next level down.
   \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
     \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
     \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
-  \else
-    \let\nonarrowing = \relax
+    \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
+    \let\nonarrowing=\relax
   \fi
-  \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
 }
 
-% If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
-% If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
-% This affects the following displayed environments:
-%    @example, @display, @format, @lisp
-%
-\def\smallword{small}
-\def\nosmallword{nosmall}
-\let\SETdispenvsize\relax
-\def\setnormaldispenv{%
-  \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
-    % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
-    % line.  This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
-    % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
-    % to change the fonts afterward.
-    \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
-    \smallexamplefonts \rm
-  \fi
-}
-\def\setsmalldispenv{%
-  \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
-  \else
-    \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
-    \smallexamplefonts \rm
-  \fi
-}
+% Define the \E... control sequence only if we are inside the particular
+% environment, so the error checking in \end will work.
+%
+% To end an @example-like environment, we first end the paragraph (via
+% \afterenvbreak's vertical glue), and then the group.  That way we keep
+% the zero \parskip that the environments set -- \parskip glue will be
+% inserted at the beginning of the next paragraph in the document, after
+% the environment.
+%
+\def\nonfillfinish{\afterenvbreak\endgroup}
 
-% We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
-% Let's do it by one command:
-\def\makedispenv #1#2{
-  \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
-  \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
-  \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
-  \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
+% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font.
+\def\lisp{\begingroup
+  \nonfillstart
+  \let\Elisp = \nonfillfinish
+  \tt
+  \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
+  \gobble       % eat return
 }
 
-% Define two synonyms:
-\def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
-  \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
-  \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
-}
+% @example: Same as @lisp.
+\def\example{\begingroup \def\Eexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\lisp}
 
-% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
-%
 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
 % Originally contributed by Pavel xerox 
+\def\smalllisp{\begingroup
+  \def\Esmalllisp{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}%
+  \def\Esmallexample{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}%
+  \smallexamplefonts
+  \lisp
+}
+\let\smallexample = \smalllisp
+
+
+% @display: same as @lisp except keep current font.
 %
-\maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{%
+\def\display{\begingroup
   \nonfillstart
-  \tt\quoteexpand
-  \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
-  \gobble       % eat return
+  \let\Edisplay = \nonfillfinish
+  \gobble
 }
-% @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
 %
-\makedispenv {display}{%
-  \nonfillstart
-  \gobble
+% @smalldisplay: @display plus smaller fonts.
+%
+\def\smalldisplay{\begingroup
+  \def\Esmalldisplay{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}%
+  \smallexamplefonts \rm
+  \display
 }
 
-% @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
+% @format: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
 %
-\makedispenv{format}{%
-  \let\nonarrowing = t%
+\def\format{\begingroup
+  \let\nonarrowing = t
   \nonfillstart
+  \let\Eformat = \nonfillfinish
   \gobble
 }
-
-% @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
-\envdef\flushleft{%
-  \let\nonarrowing = t%
-  \nonfillstart
-  \gobble
+%
+% @smallformat: @format plus smaller fonts.
+%
+\def\smallformat{\begingroup
+  \def\Esmallformat{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}%
+  \smallexamplefonts \rm
+  \format
 }
-\let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
+
+% @flushleft (same as @format).
+%
+\def\flushleft{\begingroup \def\Eflushleft{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}\format}
 
 % @flushright.
 %
-\envdef\flushright{%
-  \let\nonarrowing = t%
+\def\flushright{\begingroup
+  \let\nonarrowing = t
   \nonfillstart
+  \let\Eflushright = \nonfillfinish
   \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill
   \gobble
 }
-\let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
 
 
 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
-% and narrows the margins.  We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
-% we're doing normal filling.  So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
-% \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
+% and narrows the margins.
 %
-\envdef\quotation{%
+\def\quotation{%
+  \begingroup\inENV %This group ends at the end of the @quotation body
   {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
   \parindent=0pt
+  % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
+  % doing normal filling. So to avoid extra space below the environment...
+  \def\Equotation{\parskip = 0pt \nonfillfinish}%
   %
   % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
   \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
     \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
     \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
     \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
-  \else
     \let\nonarrowing = \relax
   \fi
-  \parsearg\quotationlabel
-}
-
-% We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
-% doing normal filling.
-%
-\def\Equotation{%
-  \par
-  \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
-    % indent a bit.
-    \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
-  \fi
-  {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
-}
-
-% If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
-\def\quotationlabel#1{%
-  \def\temp{#1}%
-  \ifx\temp\empty \else
-    {\bf #1: }%
-  \fi
 }
 
 
@@ -5995,7 +4739,7 @@
 %
 % [Knuth] p. 380
 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
-  \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
+  \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=12}\dospecials}
 %
 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
 % Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font
@@ -6029,34 +4773,6 @@
 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
 %
 \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup}
-
-% Allow an option to not replace quotes with a regular directed right
-% quote/apostrophe (char 0x27), but instead use the undirected quote
-% from cmtt (char 0x0d).  The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it
-% the default, but it works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least
-% evince), the lilypond developers report.  xpdf does work with the
-% regular 0x27.  
-% 
-\def\codequoteright{%
-  \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
-    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
-      '%
-    \else \char'15 \fi
-  \else \char'15 \fi
-}
-%
-% and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
-% Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
-% the code environments to do likewise.
-% 
-\def\codequoteleft{%
-  \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
-    \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
-      `%
-    \else \char'22 \fi
-  \else \char'22 \fi
-}
-%
 \begingroup
   \catcode`\^^I=\active
   \gdef\tabexpand{%
@@ -6069,25 +4785,13 @@
       \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
     }%
   }
-  \catcode`\'=\active
-  \gdef\rquoteexpand{\catcode\rquoteChar=\active \def'{\codequoteright}}%
-  %
-  \catcode`\`=\active
-  \gdef\lquoteexpand{\catcode\lquoteChar=\active \def`{\codequoteleft}}%
-  %
-  \gdef\quoteexpand{\rquoteexpand \lquoteexpand}%
 \endgroup
-
-% start the verbatim environment.
 \def\setupverbatim{%
-  \let\nonarrowing = t%
-  \nonfillstart
   % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
   \tt
   \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
   \catcode`\`=\active
   \tabexpand
-  \quoteexpand
   % Respect line breaks,
   % print special symbols as themselves, and
   % make each space count
@@ -6104,7 +4808,7 @@
 %
 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
 \begingroup
-  \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
+  \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=12\catcode`\}=12
   \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
 \endgroup
 %
@@ -6121,6 +4825,13 @@
 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
 %
 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
+%% Include LaTeX hack for completeness -- never know
+%% \begingroup
+%% \catcode`|=0 \catcode`[=1
+%% \catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=12\catcode`\}=12\catcode`\ =\active
+%% \catcode`\\=12|gdef|doverbatim#1 end verbatim[
+%% #1|endgroup|def|Everbatim[]|end[verbatim]]
+%% |endgroup
 %
 \begingroup
   \catcode`\ =\active
@@ -6128,32 +4839,54 @@
   % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
   % of the @verbatim input line itself.  Otherwise we get an extra blank
   % line in the output.
-  \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2 end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
-  % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
-  % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
+  \gdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2 end verbatim{#2\end{verbatim}}%
 \endgroup
 %
-\envdef\verbatim{%
-    \setupverbatim\doverbatim
+\def\verbatim{%
+  \def\Everbatim{\nonfillfinish\endgroup}%
+  \begingroup
+    \nonfillstart
+    \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
+    \begingroup\setupverbatim\doverbatim
 }
-\let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
-
 
 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
 %
-\def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
+% Allow normal characters that we make active in the argument (a file name).
+\def\verbatiminclude{%
+  \begingroup
+    \catcode`\\=\other
+    \catcode`~=\other
+    \catcode`^=\other
+    \catcode`_=\other
+    \catcode`|=\other
+    \catcode`<=\other
+    \catcode`>=\other
+    \catcode`+=\other
+    \parsearg\doverbatiminclude
+}
+\def\setupverbatiminclude{%
+  \begingroup
+    \nonfillstart
+    \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
+    \begingroup\setupverbatim
+}
 %
 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
-  {%
-    \makevalueexpandable
-    \setupverbatim
-    \input #1
-    \afterenvbreak
-  }%
+     % Restore active chars for included file.
+  \endgroup
+  \begingroup
+    \let\value=\expandablevalue
+    \def\thisfile{#1}%
+    \expandafter\expandafter\setupverbatiminclude\input\thisfile
+  \endgroup
+  \nonfillfinish
+  \endgroup
 }
 
 % @copying ... @end copying.
-% Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
+% Save the text away for @insertcopying later.  Many commands won't be
+% allowed in this context, but that's ok.
 %
 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
@@ -6162,360 +4895,644 @@
 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
 % possible is very desirable.
 %
-\def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
-\def\docopying#1 end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
-%
-\def\insertcopying{%
-  \begingroup
-    \parindent = 0pt  % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
-    \scanexp\copyingtext
-  \endgroup
+\def\copying{\begingroup
+  % Define a command to swallow text until we reach ` end copying'.
+  % \ is the escape char in this texinfo.tex file, so it is the
+  % delimiter for the command; @ will be the escape char when we read
+  % it, but that doesn't matter.
+  \long\def\docopying##1\end copying{\gdef\copyingtext{##1}\enddocopying}%
+  %
+  % We must preserve ^^M's in the input file; see \insertcopying below.
+  \catcode`\^^M = \active
+  \docopying
+}
+
+% What we do to finish off the copying text.
+%
+\def\enddocopying{\endgroup\ignorespaces}
+
+% @insertcopying.  Here we must play games with ^^M's.  On the one hand,
+% we need them to delimit commands such as ` end quotation', so they
+% must be active.  On the other hand, we certainly don't want every
+% end-of-line to be a \par, as would happen with the normal active
+% definition of ^^M.  On the third hand, two ^^M's in a row should still
+% generate a \par.
+%
+% Our approach is to make ^^M insert a space and a penalty1 normally;
+% then it can also check if \lastpenalty=1.  If it does, then manually
+% do \par.
+%
+% This messes up the normal definitions of @c[omment], so we redefine
+% it.  Similarly for @ignore.  (These commands are used in the gcc
+% manual for man page generation.)
+%
+% Seems pretty fragile, most line-oriented commands will presumably
+% fail, but for the limited use of getting the copying text (which
+% should be quite simple) inserted, we can hope it's ok.
+%
+{\catcode`\^^M=\active %
+\gdef\insertcopying{\begingroup %
+  \parindent = 0pt  % looks wrong on title page
+  \def^^M{%
+    \ifnum \lastpenalty=1 %
+      \par %
+    \else %
+      \space \penalty 1 %
+    \fi %
+  }%
+  %
+  % Fix @c[omment] for catcode 13 ^^M's.
+  \def\c##1^^M{\ignorespaces}%
+  \let\comment = \c %
+  %
+  % Don't bother jumping through all the hoops that \doignore does, it
+  % would be very hard since the catcodes are already set.
+  \long\def\ignore##1\end ignore{\ignorespaces}%
+  %
+  \copyingtext %
+\endgroup}%
 }
 
-
 \message{defuns,}
 % @defun etc.
 
 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
-\newcount\defunpenalty
 
-% Start the processing of @deffn:
-\def\startdefun{%
-  \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
-    \medbreak
-    \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
-                        % following @def command, see below.
+\newcount\parencount
+
+% We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
+%
+\def\activeparens{%
+  \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
+  \catcode`\&=\active
+  \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
+}
+
+% Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
+\let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
+
+{\activeparens % Now, smart parens don't turn on until &foo (see \amprm)
+
+% Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc.  For example,
+% if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
+% so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
+\global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
+\global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
+
+\gdef\functionparens{\boldbrax\let&=\amprm\parencount=0 }
+\gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
+% This is used to turn on special parens
+% but make & act ordinary (given that it's active).
+\gdef\boldbraxnoamp{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb\let&=\ampnr}
+
+% Definitions of (, ) and & used in args for functions.
+% This is the definition of ( outside of all parentheses.
+\gdef\oprm#1 {{\rm\char`\(}#1 \bf \let(=\opnested
+  \global\advance\parencount by 1
+}
+%
+% This is the definition of ( when already inside a level of parens.
+\gdef\opnested{\char`\(\global\advance\parencount by 1 }
+%
+\gdef\clrm{% Print a paren in roman if it is taking us back to depth of 0.
+  % also in that case restore the outer-level definition of (.
+  \ifnum \parencount=1 {\rm \char `\)}\sl \let(=\oprm \else \char `\) \fi
+  \global\advance \parencount by -1 }
+% If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
+\gdef\amprm#1 {{\rm\&#1}\let(=\oprm \let)=\clrm\ }
+%
+\gdef\normalparens{\boldbrax\let&=\ampnr}
+} % End of definition inside \activeparens
+%% These parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than the
+%% contained text.  This is especially needed for [ and ]
+\def\opnr{{\sf\char`\(}\global\advance\parencount by 1 }
+\def\clnr{{\sf\char`\)}\global\advance\parencount by -1 }
+\let\ampnr = \&
+\def\lbrb{{\bf\char`\[}}
+\def\rbrb{{\bf\char`\]}}
+
+% Active &'s sneak into the index arguments, so make sure it's defined.
+{
+  \catcode`& = \active
+  \global\let& = \ampnr
+}
+
+% \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
+% #1 is the function name.
+% #2 is the type of definition, such as "Function".
+%
+\def\defname#1#2{%
+  % How we'll output the type name.  Putting it in brackets helps
+  % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
+  % just below it.
+  \ifempty{#2}%
+    \def\defnametype{}%
   \else
-    % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
-    % which is there to keep the function description together with its
-    % header.  But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
-    % break somewhere.  Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
-    % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
-    % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
-    % a break between a section heading and a defun.
-    %
-    % As a minor refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
-    % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
-    % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
-    % @def command.
-    \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
-    %
-    % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
-    % But do insert the glue.
-    \medskip  % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
+    \def\defnametype{[\rm #2]}%
   \fi
   %
+  % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
+  \dimen2=\leftskip
+  \advance\dimen2 by -\defbodyindent
+  %
+  % Figure out values for the paragraph shape.
+  \setbox0=\hbox{\hskip \deflastargmargin{\defnametype}}%
+  \dimen0=\hsize \advance \dimen0 by -\wd0  % compute size for first line
+  \dimen1=\hsize \advance \dimen1 by -\defargsindent  % size for continuations
+  \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen1
+  %
+  % Output arg 2 ("Function" or some such) but stuck inside a box of
+  % width 0 so it does not interfere with linebreaking.
+  \noindent
+  %
+  {% Adjust \hsize to exclude the ambient margins,
+   % so that \rightline will obey them.
+   \advance \hsize by -\dimen2
+   \dimen3 = 0pt  % was -1.25pc
+   \rlap{\rightline{\defnametype\kern\dimen3}}%
+  }%
+  %
+  % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
+  \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
+  \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
+  \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+  {\df #1}\enskip        % output function name
+  % \defunargs will be called next to output the arguments, if any.
+}
+
+% Common pieces to start any @def...
+% #1 is the \E... control sequence to end the definition (which we define).
+% #2 is the \...x control sequence (which our caller defines).
+% #3 is the control sequence to process the header, such as \defunheader.
+%
+\def\parsebodycommon#1#2#3{%
+  \begingroup\inENV
+  % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
+  % which is there to keep the function description together with its
+  % header.  But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
+  % break somewhere.  Check for penalty 10002 (inserted by
+  % \defargscommonending) instead of 10000, since the sectioning
+  % commands insert a \penalty10000, and we don't want to allow a break
+  % between a section heading and a defun.
+  \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \fi
+  %
+  % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
+  % But do insert the glue.
+  \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \medbreak
+  \else \medskip  % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
+  \fi
+  %
+  % Define the \E... end token that this defining construct specifies
+  % so that it will exit this group.
+  \def#1{\endgraf\endgroup\medbreak}%
+  %
   \parindent=0in
   \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
   \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
 }
 
-\def\dodefunx#1{%
-  % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
-  \checkenv#1%
-  %
-  % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
-  % It's not a great place, though.
-  \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
+% Common part of the \...x definitions.
+%
+\def\defxbodycommon{%
+  % As with \parsebodycommon above, allow line break if we have multiple
+  % x headers in a row.  It's not a great place, though.
+  \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \fi
   %
-  % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
-  \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
+  \begingroup\obeylines
 }
-\def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
 
-% \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
+% Process body of @defun, @deffn, @defmac, etc.
 %
-\def\printdefunline#1#2{%
-  \begingroup
-    % call \deffnheader:
-    #1#2 \endheader
-    % common ending:
-    \interlinepenalty = 10000
-    \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
-    \endgraf
-    \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
-    \penalty\defunpenalty  % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
-    % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
-    % rendering the following check redundant.  But we don't optimize.
-    \checkparencounts
-  \endgroup
+\def\defparsebody#1#2#3{%
+  \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+  \def#2{\defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit#3}%
+  \catcode\equalChar=\active
+  \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens
+  \spacesplit#3%
 }
 
-\def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
-
-% \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
-% the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader.
+% #1, #2, #3 are the common arguments (see \parsebodycommon above).
+% #4, delimited by the space, is the class name.
 %
-\def\makedefun#1{%
-  \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
-  \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
-    \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
-  \temp
+\def\defmethparsebody#1#2#3#4 {%
+  \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+  \def#2##1 {\defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##1}}}%
+  \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens
+  % The \empty here prevents misinterpretation of a construct such as
+  %   @deffn {whatever} {Enharmonic comma}
+  % See comments at \deftpparsebody, although in our case we don't have
+  % to remove the \empty afterwards, since it is empty.
+  \spacesplit{#3{#4}}\empty
 }
 
-% \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
+% Used for @deftypemethod and @deftypeivar.
+% #1, #2, #3 are the common arguments (see \defparsebody).
+% #4, delimited by a space, is the class name.
+% #5 is the method's return type.
 %
-% Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
-% \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
+\def\deftypemethparsebody#1#2#3#4 #5 {%
+  \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+  \def#2##1 ##2 {\defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##1}{##2}}}%
+  \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens
+  \spacesplit{#3{#4}{#5}}%
+}
+
+% Used for @deftypeop.  The change from \deftypemethparsebody is an
+% extra argument at the beginning which is the `category', instead of it
+% being the hardwired string `Method' or `Instance Variable'.  We have
+% to account for this both in the \...x definition and in parsing the
+% input at hand.  Thus also need a control sequence (passed as #5) for
+% the \E... definition to assign the category name to.
 %
-\def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
-  \envdef#1{%
-    \startdefun
-    \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
-  }%
-  \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
-  \def#3%
+\def\deftypeopparsebody#1#2#3#4#5 #6 {%
+  \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+  \def#2##1 ##2 ##3 {\def#4{##1}%
+    \defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##2}{##3}}}%
+  \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens
+  \spacesplit{#3{#5}{#6}}%
 }
 
-%%% Untyped functions:
+% For @defop.
+\def\defopparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {%
+  \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+  \def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}%
+    \defxbodycommon \activeparens \spacesplit{#3{##2}}}%
+  \begingroup\obeylines\activeparens
+  \spacesplit{#3{#5}}%
+}
 
-% @deffn category name args
-\makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
+% These parsing functions are similar to the preceding ones
+% except that they do not make parens into active characters.
+% These are used for "variables" since they have no arguments.
+%
+\def\defvarparsebody #1#2#3{%
+  \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+  \def#2{\defxbodycommon \spacesplit#3}%
+  \catcode\equalChar=\active
+  \begingroup\obeylines
+  \spacesplit#3%
+}
 
-% @deffn category class name args
-\makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
+% @defopvar.
+\def\defopvarparsebody #1#2#3#4#5 {%
+  \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+  \def#2##1 ##2 {\def#4{##1}%
+    \defxbodycommon \spacesplit{#3{##2}}}%
+  \begingroup\obeylines
+  \spacesplit{#3{#5}}%
+}
 
-% \defopon {category on}class name args
-\def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
+\def\defvrparsebody#1#2#3#4 {%
+  \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+  \def#2##1 {\defxbodycommon \spacesplit{#3{##1}}}%
+  \begingroup\obeylines
+  \spacesplit{#3{#4}}%
+}
 
-% \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
+% This loses on ` deftp {Data Type} {struct termios}' -- it thinks the
+% type is just `struct', because we lose the braces in `{struct
+% termios}' when \spacesplit reads its undelimited argument.  Sigh.
+% \let\deftpparsebody=\defvrparsebody
+%
+% So, to get around this, we put \empty in with the type name.  That
+% way, TeX won't find exactly `{...}' as an undelimited argument, and
+% won't strip off the braces.
 %
-\def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
-  % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
-  \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
-  \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
+\def\deftpparsebody #1#2#3#4 {%
+  \parsebodycommon{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+  \def#2##1 {\defxbodycommon \spacesplit{#3{##1}}}%
+  \begingroup\obeylines
+  \spacesplit{\parsetpheaderline{#3{#4}}}\empty
 }
 
-%%% Typed functions:
+% Fine, but then we have to eventually remove the \empty *and* the
+% braces (if any).  That's what this does.
+%
+\def\removeemptybraces\empty#1\relax{#1}
 
-% @deftypefn category type name args
-\makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
+% After \spacesplit has done its work, this is called -- #1 is the final
+% thing to call, #2 the type name (which starts with \empty), and #3
+% (which might be empty) the arguments.
+%
+\def\parsetpheaderline#1#2#3{%
+  #1{\removeemptybraces#2\relax}{#3}%
+}%
 
-% @deftypeop category class type name args
-\makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
+% Split up #2 (the rest of the input line) at the first space token.
+% call #1 with two arguments:
+%  the first is all of #2 before the space token,
+%  the second is all of #2 after that space token.
+% If #2 contains no space token, all of it is passed as the first arg
+% and the second is passed as empty.
+%
+{\obeylines %
+ \gdef\spacesplit#1#2^^M{\endgroup\spacesplitx{#1}#2 \relax\spacesplitx}%
+ \long\gdef\spacesplitx#1#2 #3#4\spacesplitx{%
+   \ifx\relax #3%
+     #1{#2}{}%
+   \else %
+     #1{#2}{#3#4}%
+   \fi}%
+}
 
-% \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
-\def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
+% Define @defun.
 
-% \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
+% This is called to end the arguments processing for all the @def... commands.
 %
-\def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
-  \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
-  \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
+\def\defargscommonending{%
+  \interlinepenalty = 10000
+  \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
+  \endgraf
+  \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
+  \penalty 10002  % signal to \parsebodycommon and \defxbodycommon.
 }
 
-%%% Typed variables:
+% This expands the args and terminates the paragraph they comprise.
+%
+\def\defunargs#1{\functionparens \sl
+% Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars.
+% Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar.
+% Set the font temporarily and use \font in case \setfont made \tensl a macro.
+{\tensl\hyphenchar\font=0}%
+#1%
+{\tensl\hyphenchar\font=45}%
+\ifnum\parencount=0 \else \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}\fi%
+  \defargscommonending
+}
 
-% @deftypevr category type var args
-\makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
+\def\deftypefunargs #1{%
+% Expand, preventing hyphenation at `-' chars.
+% Note that groups don't affect changes in \hyphenchar.
+% Use \boldbraxnoamp, not \functionparens, so that & is not special.
+\boldbraxnoamp
+\tclose{#1}% avoid \code because of side effects on active chars
+  \defargscommonending
+}
 
-% @deftypecv category class type var args
-\makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
+% Do complete processing of one @defun or @defunx line already parsed.
 
-% \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
-\def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
+% @deffn Command forward-char nchars
 
-% \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
-%
-\def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
-  \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
-  \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
+\def\deffn{\defmethparsebody\Edeffn\deffnx\deffnheader}
+
+\def\deffnheader #1#2#3{\doind {fn}{\code{#2}}%
+\begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\defunargs{#3}\endgroup %
+\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
 }
 
-%%% Untyped variables:
+% @defun == @deffn Function
 
-% @defvr category var args
-\makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
+\def\defun{\defparsebody\Edefun\defunx\defunheader}
+
+\def\defunheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index
+\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDeffunc}%
+\defunargs {#2}\endgroup %
+\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
+}
 
-% @defcv category class var args
-\makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
+% @deftypefun int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar})
 
-% \defcvof {category of}class var args
-\def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
+\def\deftypefun{\defparsebody\Edeftypefun\deftypefunx\deftypefunheader}
 
-%%% Type:
-% @deftp category name args
-\makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
-  \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
-  \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
+% #1 is the data type.  #2 is the name and args.
+\def\deftypefunheader #1#2{\deftypefunheaderx{#1}#2 \relax}
+% #1 is the data type, #2 the name, #3 the args.
+\def\deftypefunheaderx #1#2 #3\relax{%
+\doind {fn}{\code{#2}}% Make entry in function index
+\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$#2}{\putwordDeftypefun}%
+\deftypefunargs {#3}\endgroup %
+\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
 }
 
-% Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
-\makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
-\makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
-\makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
-\makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
-\makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
-\makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
-\makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
-\makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
-\makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
-\makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
-\makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
+% @deftypefn {Library Function} int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar})
 
-% \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
-% #1 is the category, such as "Function".
-% #2 is the return type, if any.
-% #3 is the function name.
+\def\deftypefn{\defmethparsebody\Edeftypefn\deftypefnx\deftypefnheader}
+
+% \defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$
+% puts #1 in @code, followed by a space, but does nothing if #1 is null.
+\def\defheaderxcond#1#2$.${\ifx#1\relax\else\code{#1#2} \fi}
+
+% #1 is the classification.  #2 is the data type.  #3 is the name and args.
+\def\deftypefnheader #1#2#3{\deftypefnheaderx{#1}{#2}#3 \relax}
+% #1 is the classification, #2 the data type, #3 the name, #4 the args.
+\def\deftypefnheaderx #1#2#3 #4\relax{%
+\doind {fn}{\code{#3}}% Make entry in function index
+\begingroup
+\normalparens % notably, turn off `&' magic, which prevents
+%               at least some C++ text from working
+\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{#1}%
+\deftypefunargs {#4}\endgroup %
+\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
+}
+
+% @defmac == @deffn Macro
+
+\def\defmac{\defparsebody\Edefmac\defmacx\defmacheader}
+
+\def\defmacheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index
+\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefmac}%
+\defunargs {#2}\endgroup %
+\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
+}
+
+% @defspec == @deffn Special Form
+
+\def\defspec{\defparsebody\Edefspec\defspecx\defspecheader}
+
+\def\defspecheader #1#2{\doind {fn}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in function index
+\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefspec}%
+\defunargs {#2}\endgroup %
+\catcode\equalChar=\other % Turn off change made in \defparsebody
+}
+
+% @defop CATEGORY CLASS OPERATION ARG...
 %
-% We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
+\def\defop #1 {\def\defoptype{#1}%
+\defopparsebody\Edefop\defopx\defopheader\defoptype}
 %
-\def\defname#1#2#3{%
-  % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
-  \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
-  %
-  % How we'll format the type name.  Putting it in brackets helps
-  % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
-  % just below it.
-  \def\temp{#1}%
-  \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
-  %
-  % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
-  % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
-  % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
-  \dimen0=\hsize  \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0  \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
-  % The continuations:
-  \dimen2=\hsize  \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
-  % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
-  \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
-  %
-  % Put the type name to the right margin.
-  \noindent
-  \hbox to 0pt{%
-    \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
-    % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
-    \kern\leftskip
-    % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
-  }%
-  %
-  % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
-  \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
-  \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
-  {%
-    % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
-    % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
-    % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
-    %   common to leave accents off identifiers.  The result looks ok in
-    %   tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
-    % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
-    % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
-    %   one has made identifiers using them :).
-    \df \tt
-    \def\temp{#2}% return value type
-    \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
-    #3% output function name
-  }%
-  {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
-  %
-  \boldbrax
-  % arguments will be output next, if any.
+\def\defopheader#1#2#3{%
+  \dosubind{fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% function index entry
+  \begingroup
+    \defname{#2}{\defoptype\ \putwordon\ #1}%
+    \defunargs{#3}%
+  \endgroup
 }
 
-% Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
-% tt for the name.  This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
-% the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
-% distinguishable.  Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
+% @deftypeop CATEGORY CLASS TYPE OPERATION ARG...
 %
-\def\defunargs#1{%
-  % use sl by default (not ttsl),
-  % tt for the names.
-  \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
-  %
-  % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
-  % want a way to get ttsl.  Let's try @var for that.
-  \let\var=\ttslanted
-  #1%
-  \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
+\def\deftypeop #1 {\def\deftypeopcategory{#1}%
+  \deftypeopparsebody\Edeftypeop\deftypeopx\deftypeopheader
+                       \deftypeopcategory}
+%
+% #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the operation name, #4 the args.
+\def\deftypeopheader#1#2#3#4{%
+  \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index
+  \begingroup
+    \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}
+            {\deftypeopcategory\ \putwordon\ \code{#1}}%
+    \deftypefunargs{#4}%
+  \endgroup
 }
 
-% We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
+% @deftypemethod CLASS TYPE METHOD ARG...
 %
-\def\activeparens{%
-  \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
-  \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
-  \catcode`\&=\active
+\def\deftypemethod{%
+  \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypemethod\deftypemethodx\deftypemethodheader}
+%
+% #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the method name, #4 the args.
+\def\deftypemethodheader#1#2#3#4{%
+  \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index
+  \begingroup
+    \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}%
+    \deftypefunargs{#4}%
+  \endgroup
 }
 
-% Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
-\let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
-
-% Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc.  For example,
-% if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
-% so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
-{
-  \activeparens
-  \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
-  \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
-  \global\let& = \&
+% @deftypeivar CLASS TYPE VARNAME
+%
+\def\deftypeivar{%
+  \deftypemethparsebody\Edeftypeivar\deftypeivarx\deftypeivarheader}
+%
+% #1 is the class name, #2 the data type, #3 the variable name.
+\def\deftypeivarheader#1#2#3{%
+  \dosubind{vr}{\code{#3}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% entry in variable index
+  \begingroup
+    \defname{\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}
+            {\putwordInstanceVariableof\ \code{#1}}%
+    \defvarargs{#3}%
+  \endgroup
+}
 
-  \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
-  \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
+% @defmethod == @defop Method
+%
+\def\defmethod{\defmethparsebody\Edefmethod\defmethodx\defmethodheader}
+%
+% #1 is the class name, #2 the method name, #3 the args.
+\def\defmethodheader#1#2#3{%
+  \dosubind{fn}{\code{#2}}{\putwordon\ \code{#1}}% entry in function index
+  \begingroup
+    \defname{#2}{\putwordMethodon\ \code{#1}}%
+    \defunargs{#3}%
+  \endgroup
 }
 
-\newcount\parencount
+% @defcv {Class Option} foo-class foo-flag
 
-% If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
-\newif\ifampseen
-\def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
+\def\defcv #1 {\def\defcvtype{#1}%
+\defopvarparsebody\Edefcv\defcvx\defcvarheader\defcvtype}
 
-\def\parenfont{%
-  \ifampseen
-    % At the first level, print parens in roman,
-    % otherwise use the default font.
-    \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
-  \else
-    % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
-    % the contained text.  This is especially needed for [ and ] .
-    \sf
-  \fi
+\def\defcvarheader #1#2#3{%
+  \dosubind{vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% variable index entry
+  \begingroup
+    \defname{#2}{\defcvtype\ \putwordof\ #1}%
+    \defvarargs{#3}%
+  \endgroup
 }
-\def\infirstlevel#1{%
-  \ifampseen
-    \ifnum\parencount=1
-      #1%
-    \fi
-  \fi
+
+% @defivar CLASS VARNAME == @defcv {Instance Variable} CLASS VARNAME
+%
+\def\defivar{\defvrparsebody\Edefivar\defivarx\defivarheader}
+%
+\def\defivarheader#1#2#3{%
+  \dosubind{vr}{\code{#2}}{\putwordof\ \code{#1}}% entry in var index
+  \begingroup
+    \defname{#2}{\putwordInstanceVariableof\ #1}%
+    \defvarargs{#3}%
+  \endgroup
 }
-\def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
 
-\def\opnr{%
-  \global\advance\parencount by 1
-  {\parenfont(}%
-  \infirstlevel \bfafterword
+% @defvar
+% First, define the processing that is wanted for arguments of @defvar.
+% This is actually simple: just print them in roman.
+% This must expand the args and terminate the paragraph they make up
+\def\defvarargs #1{\normalparens #1%
+  \defargscommonending
 }
-\def\clnr{%
-  {\parenfont)}%
-  \infirstlevel \sl
-  \global\advance\parencount by -1
-}
-
-\newcount\brackcount
-\def\lbrb{%
-  \global\advance\brackcount by 1
-  {\bf[}%
-}
-\def\rbrb{%
-  {\bf]}%
-  \global\advance\brackcount by -1
-}
-
-\def\checkparencounts{%
-  \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
-  \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
-}
-% these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
-% has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
-\def\badparencount{%
-  \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
-  \global\parencount=0
-}
-\def\badbrackcount{%
-  \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
-  \global\brackcount=0
+
+% @defvr Counter foo-count
+
+\def\defvr{\defvrparsebody\Edefvr\defvrx\defvrheader}
+
+\def\defvrheader #1#2#3{\doind {vr}{\code{#2}}%
+\begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\defvarargs{#3}\endgroup}
+
+% @defvar == @defvr Variable
+
+\def\defvar{\defvarparsebody\Edefvar\defvarx\defvarheader}
+
+\def\defvarheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index
+\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefvar}%
+\defvarargs {#2}\endgroup %
 }
 
+% @defopt == @defvr {User Option}
+
+\def\defopt{\defvarparsebody\Edefopt\defoptx\defoptheader}
+
+\def\defoptheader #1#2{\doind {vr}{\code{#1}}% Make entry in var index
+\begingroup\defname {#1}{\putwordDefopt}%
+\defvarargs {#2}\endgroup %
+}
+
+% @deftypevar int foobar
+
+\def\deftypevar{\defvarparsebody\Edeftypevar\deftypevarx\deftypevarheader}
+
+% #1 is the data type.  #2 is the name, perhaps followed by text that
+% is actually part of the data type, which should not be put into the index.
+\def\deftypevarheader #1#2{%
+\dovarind#2 \relax% Make entry in variables index
+\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#1\relax$.$#2}{\putwordDeftypevar}%
+  \defargscommonending
+\endgroup}
+\def\dovarind#1 #2\relax{\doind{vr}{\code{#1}}}
+
+% @deftypevr {Global Flag} int enable
+
+\def\deftypevr{\defvrparsebody\Edeftypevr\deftypevrx\deftypevrheader}
+
+\def\deftypevrheader #1#2#3{\dovarind#3 \relax%
+\begingroup\defname {\defheaderxcond#2\relax$.$#3}{#1}
+  \defargscommonending
+\endgroup}
+
+% Now define @deftp
+% Args are printed in bold, a slight difference from @defvar.
+
+\def\deftpargs #1{\bf \defvarargs{#1}}
+
+% @deftp Class window height width ...
+
+\def\deftp{\deftpparsebody\Edeftp\deftpx\deftpheader}
+
+\def\deftpheader #1#2#3{\doind {tp}{\code{#2}}%
+\begingroup\defname {#2}{#1}\deftpargs{#3}\endgroup}
+
+% These definitions are used if you use @defunx (etc.)
+% anywhere other than immediately after a @defun or @defunx.
+%
+\def\defcvx#1 {\errmessage{ defcvx in invalid context}}
+\def\deffnx#1 {\errmessage{ deffnx in invalid context}}
+\def\defivarx#1 {\errmessage{ defivarx in invalid context}}
+\def\defmacx#1 {\errmessage{ defmacx in invalid context}}
+\def\defmethodx#1 {\errmessage{ defmethodx in invalid context}}
+\def\defoptx #1 {\errmessage{ defoptx in invalid context}}
+\def\defopx#1 {\errmessage{ defopx in invalid context}}
+\def\defspecx#1 {\errmessage{ defspecx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftpx#1 {\errmessage{ deftpx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftypefnx#1 {\errmessage{ deftypefnx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftypefunx#1 {\errmessage{ deftypefunx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftypeivarx#1 {\errmessage{ deftypeivarx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftypemethodx#1 {\errmessage{ deftypemethodx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftypeopx#1 {\errmessage{ deftypeopx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftypevarx#1 {\errmessage{ deftypevarx in invalid context}}
+\def\deftypevrx#1 {\errmessage{ deftypevrx in invalid context}}
+\def\defunx#1 {\errmessage{ defunx in invalid context}}
+\def\defvarx#1 {\errmessage{ defvarx in invalid context}}
+\def\defvrx#1 {\errmessage{ defvrx in invalid context}}
+
 
 \message{macros,}
 % @macro.
@@ -6523,68 +5540,42 @@
 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
-  \newwrite\macscribble
-  \def\scantokens#1{%
-    \toks0={#1}%
-    \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
-    \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
-    \immediate\closeout\macscribble
-    \input \jobname.tmp
-  }
-\fi
-
-\def\scanmacro#1{%
-  \begingroup
-    \newlinechar`\^^M
-    \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
-    % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
-    % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
-    % backslash to get it printed correctly.  Previously, we had
-    % \catcode`\\=\other instead.  We'll see whether a problem appears
-    % with macro expansion.				--kasal, 19aug04
-    \catcode`\ =0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
-    % ... and \example
-    \spaceisspace
-    %
-    % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
-    % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
-    %							--kasal, 29nov03
-    \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
-  \endgroup
-}
-
-\def\scanexp#1{%
-  \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
-  \temp
+ \newwrite\macscribble
+ \def\scanmacro#1{%
+   \begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M
+   % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
+   \catcode`\ =0 \catcode`\\=\other \escapechar=`\@
+   % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
+   \toks0={#1\endinput}%
+   \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
+   \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
+   \immediate\closeout\macscribble
+   \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
+   \input \jobname.tmp
+   \endgroup
 }
+\else
+\def\scanmacro#1{%
+\begingroup \newlinechar`\^^M
+% Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
+\catcode`\ =0 \catcode`\\=\other \escapechar=`\@
+\let\xeatspaces\eatspaces\scantokens{#1\endinput}\endgroup}
+\fi
 
 \newcount\paramno   % Count of parameters
 \newtoks\macname    % Macro name
 \newif\ifrecursive  % Is it recursive?
-
-% List of all defined macros in the form
-%    \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
-% Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
-% if there is a need.
-\def\macrolist{}
-
-% Add the macro to \macrolist
-\def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
-\def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
-     \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
-     \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
-}
+\def\macrolist{}    % List of all defined macros in the form
+                    % \do\macro1\do\macro2...
 
 % Utility routines.
-% This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
-%   \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
-% (except of course we have to play expansion games).
-% 
+% Thisdoes \let #1 = #2, except with \csnames.
 \def\cslet#1#2{%
-  \expandafter\let
-  \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
-  \csname#2\endcsname
-}
+\expandafter\expandafter
+\expandafter\let
+\expandafter\expandafter
+\csname#1\endcsname
+\csname#2\endcsname}
 
 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
@@ -6607,45 +5598,34 @@
 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
 
-% Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
-% them to avoid their expansion.  Must do this non-globally, to
-% confine the change to the current group.
-
 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
 % done by  making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
 
-\def\scanctxt{%
-  \catcode`\"=\other
-  \catcode`\+=\other
-  \catcode`\<=\other
-  \catcode`\>=\other
-  \catcode`\ =\other
+\def\macrobodyctxt{%
+  \catcode`\~=\other
   \catcode`\^=\other
   \catcode`\_=\other
   \catcode`\|=\other
-  \catcode`\~=\other
-  \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi
-}
-
-\def\scanargctxt{%
-  \scanctxt
-  \catcode`\\=\other
-  \catcode`\^^M=\other
-}
-
-\def\macrobodyctxt{%
-  \scanctxt
+  \catcode`\<=\other
+  \catcode`\>=\other
+  \catcode`\+=\other
   \catcode`\{=\other
   \catcode`\}=\other
+  \catcode`\ =\other
   \catcode`\^^M=\other
-  \usembodybackslash
-}
+  \usembodybackslash}
 
 \def\macroargctxt{%
-  \scanctxt
-  \catcode`\\=\other
-}
+  \catcode`\~=\other
+  \catcode`\^=\other
+  \catcode`\_=\other
+  \catcode`\|=\other
+  \catcode`\<=\other
+  \catcode`\>=\other
+  \catcode`\+=\other
+  \catcode`\ =\other
+  \catcode`\\=\other}
 
 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
@@ -6676,21 +5656,25 @@
      \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
      \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
      \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
-     \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
+     % Add the macroname to \macrolist
+     \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\do}%
+     \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0
+       \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname\endcsname}%
   \fi
   \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
   \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
   \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
   \fi}
 
-\parseargdef\unmacro{%
+\def\unmacro{\parsearg\dounmacro}
+\def\dounmacro#1{%
   \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
     \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
     \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
     % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
     \begingroup
       \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
-      \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
+      \let\do\unmacrodo
       \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
     \endgroup
   \else
@@ -6702,10 +5686,10 @@
 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
 %
 \def\unmacrodo#1{%
-  \ifx #1\relax
+  \ifx#1\relax
     % remove this
   \else
-    \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
+    \noexpand\do \noexpand #1%
   \fi
 }
 
@@ -6818,31 +5802,33 @@
 % {.  If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
 % line.  Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
-\def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
+\def\braceorline#1{\let\next=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
   \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
     \expandafter\parsearg
-  \fi \macnamexxx}
+  \fi \next}
+
+% We mant to disable all macros during \shipout so that they are not
+% expanded by \write.
+\def\turnoffmacros{\begingroup \def\do##1{\let\noexpand##1=\relax}%
+  \edef\next{\macrolist}\expandafter\endgroup\next}
 
 
 % @alias.
 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
 % sign.  Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
-\def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
+\def\alias{\begingroup\obeyspaces\parsearg\aliasxxx}
 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
-\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
-  {%
-    \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
-    \addtomacrolist{#1}%
-    \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
-  }%
-  \next
-}
+\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{\ignoreactivespaces
+\edef\next{\global\let\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname=%
+           \expandafter\noexpand\csname#2\endcsname}%
+\expandafter\endgroup\next}
 
 
 \message{cross references,}
 
 \newwrite\auxfile
+
 \newif\ifhavexrefs    % True if xref values are known.
 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs  % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
 
@@ -6852,27 +5838,19 @@
   node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
 
 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
-% cross-references.  The @node line might or might not have commas, and
-% might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
-% @node foo , bar , ...
-% We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
-%
-\parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
-%
-% also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
-% @node Help-Cross,  ,  , Cross-refs
-\def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
-\def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
-
+% cross-references.
+\def\node{\ENVcheck\parsearg\nodezzz}
+\def\nodezzz#1{\nodexxx #1,\finishnodeparse}
+\def\nodexxx#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
 \let\nwnode=\node
 \let\lastnode=\empty
 
 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node.  #1 is the
 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
-%
+% 
 \def\donoderef#1{%
   \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
-    \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
+    \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
     \global\let\lastnode=\empty
   \fi
 }
@@ -6881,38 +5859,33 @@
 %
 \newcount\savesfregister
 %
-\def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
-\def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
-\def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
+\gdef\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
+\gdef\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
+\gdef\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
 
 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
-% anchor), which consists of three parts:
-% 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
-%                 or the anchor name.
-% 2) NAME-snt   - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
-%                 empty for anchors.
-% 3) NAME-pg    - the page number.
-%
-% This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat.  In the case of
-% floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
-% 4) NAME-lof   - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
+% anchor), namely NAME-title (the corresponding @chapter/etc. name),
+% NAME-pg (the page number), and NAME-snt (section number and type).
+% Called from \foonoderef.
+% 
+% We have to set dummies so commands such as @code in a section title
+% aren't expanded.  It would be nicer not to expand the titles in the
+% first place, but that is hard to do.
+%
+% Likewise, use \turnoffactive so that punctuation chars such as underscore
+% and backslash work in node names.
 %
-\def\setref#1#2{%
+\def\setref#1#2{{%
+  \atdummies
   \pdfmkdest{#1}%
+  %
   \iflinks
-    {%
-      \atdummies  % preserve commands, but don't expand them
-      \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
-	\write\auxfile{ xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
-	  ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
-      }%
-      \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}%
-      \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
-      \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
-      \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, during \shipout
-    }%
+    \turnoffactive
+    \dosetq{#1-title}{Ytitle}%
+    \dosetq{#1-pg}{Ypagenumber}%
+    \dosetq{#1-snt}{#2}%
   \fi
-}
+}}
 
 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references.  For \xrefX, #1 is
 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
@@ -6925,123 +5898,101 @@
 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
   \unsepspaces
   \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
-  \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
-  \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
-  \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
+  \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #3}%
+  \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual}%
+  \setbox0=\hbox{\printednodename}%
   \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt
     % No printed node name was explicitly given.
     \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax
       % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
-      \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
+      \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}%
     \else
       % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
       % the square brackets.  Use the real section title if we have it.
       \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
         % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
-        \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
+        \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}%
       \else
         \ifhavexrefs
           % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
-          \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
+          \def\printednodename{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
         \else
           % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
-          \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
+          \def\printednodename{\ignorespaces #1}%
         \fi%
       \fi
     \fi
   \fi
   %
-  % Make link in pdf output.
+  % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
+  % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
+  % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names.  Since some manuals
+  % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
+  % is a loss.  Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
+  % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
   \ifpdf
     \leavevmode
     \getfilename{#4}%
-    {\indexnofonts
-     \turnoffactive
-     % See comments at \activebackslashdouble.
-     {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
-      \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}%
-     %
+    {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash
      \ifnum\filenamelength>0
        \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
-         goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
+         goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{#1}%
      \else
        \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
-         goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
+         goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}%
      \fi
     }%
-    \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
+    \linkcolor
   \fi
   %
-  % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
-  % instead of "[somenode], p.3".  We distinguish them by the
-  % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
-  {%
-    % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
-    % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
-    \indexnofonts
-    \turnoffactive
-    \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
-      \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
-  }%
-  \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
-    % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
-    % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
-    \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt
-      \refx{#1-snt}{}%
-    \else
-      \printedrefname
-    \fi
-    %
-    % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
-    % "in MANUALNAME".
-    \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
-      \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
-    \fi
+  \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
+    \putwordsection{} ``\printednodename'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
   \else
-    % node/anchor (non-float) references.
+    % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
+    % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
+    % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
+    % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
+    % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
+    {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash
+     % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
+     % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
+     \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
+     \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
+    }%
+    % output the `[mynode]' via a macro.
+    \xrefprintnodename\printednodename
     %
-    % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
-    % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
-    % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names.  Since some manuals
-    % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
-    % is a loss.  Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
-    % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
-    \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
-      \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
-    \else
-      % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
-      % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
-      % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
-      % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
-      % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
-      {\turnoffactive
-       % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
-       % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
-       \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
-       \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
-      }%
-      % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
-      \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
-      %
-      % But we always want a comma and a space:
-      ,\space
-      %
-      % output the `page 3'.
-      \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
-    \fi
+    % But we always want a comma and a space:
+    ,\space
+    %
+    % output the `page 3'.
+    \turnoffactive \otherbackslash \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
   \fi
   \endlink
 \endgroup}
 
 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
 % output.  It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
-% since square brackets don't work well in some documents.  Particularly
+% since not square brackets don't work in some documents.  Particularly
 % one that Bob is working on :).
 %
 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
 
-% Things referred to by \setref.
+% \dosetq is called from \setref to do the actual \write (\iflinks).
+%
+\def\dosetq#1#2{%
+  \edef\next{\write\auxfile{\internalsetq{#1}{#2}}}%
+  \next
+}
+
+% \internalsetq{foo}{page} expands into
+%   CHARACTERS @xrdef{foo}{...expansion of \page...}
+\def\internalsetq#1#2{ xrdef{#1}{\csname #2\endcsname}}
+
+% Things to be expanded by \internalsetq.
 %
+\def\Ypagenumber{\noexpand\folio}
+\def\Ytitle{\thissection}
 \def\Ynothing{}
 \def\Yomitfromtoc{}
 \def\Ynumbered{%
@@ -7068,6 +6019,15 @@
   \fi\fi\fi
 }
 
+% Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
+% messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
+%
+\ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
+  \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
+\else
+  \def\linenumber{\the\inputlineno:\space}
+\fi
+
 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
 %
@@ -7076,7 +6036,7 @@
     \indexnofonts
     \otherbackslash
     \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
-      \csname XR#1\endcsname
+      \csname X#1\endcsname
   }%
   \ifx\thisrefX\relax
     % If not defined, say something at least.
@@ -7098,54 +6058,12 @@
   #2% Output the suffix in any case.
 }
 
-% This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file.  Usually it's
-% just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
-% collisions).  But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
-%
-\def\xrdef#1#2{%
-  {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
-   % implementation are changed to commands like @'e.  Don't let these
-   % mess up the control sequence name.
-    \indexnofonts
-    \turnoffactive
-    \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
-  }%
-  %
-  \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
-  %
-  % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
-  \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
-    % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
-    \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
-      \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
-    %
-    % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
-    \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
-      \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
-    \else
-      % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
-      \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
-    \fi
-    %
-    % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
-    % for later use in \listoffloats.
-    \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
-      {\safexrefname}}%
-  \fi
-}
-
-% Read the last existing aux file, if any.  No error if none exists.
+% This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file.
 %
-\def\tryauxfile{%
-  \openin 1 \jobname.aux
-  \ifeof 1 \else
-    \readdatafile{aux}%
-    \global\havexrefstrue
-  \fi
-  \closein 1
-}
+\def\xrdef#1{\expandafter\gdef\csname X#1\endcsname}
 
-\def\setupdatafile{%
+% Read the last existing aux file, if any.  No error if none exists.
+\def\readauxfile{\begingroup
   \catcode`\^^ =\other
   \catcode`\^^A=\other
   \catcode`\^^B=\other
@@ -7203,40 +6121,40 @@
   \catcode`\%=\other
   \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
   %
-  % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
-  % characters end up in a \csname.  It's easier than
-  % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
-  % character.  What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
-  % of the xrdef.  Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
-  % should not typeset properly.  But it works, so I'm moving on for
-  % now.  --karl, 15jan04.
-  \catcode`\\=\other
-  %
-  % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
+  % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters
   {%
-    \count1=128
+    \count 1=128
     \def\loop{%
-      \catcode\count1=\other
-      \advance\count1 by 1
-      \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi
+      \catcode\count 1=\other
+      \advance\count 1 by 1
+      \ifnum \count 1<256 \loop \fi
     }%
   }%
   %
-  % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
+  % Turn off \ as an escape so we do not lose on
+  % entries which were dumped with control sequences in their names.
+  % For example, @xrdef{$\leq $-fun}{page ...} made by @defun ^^
+  % Reference to such entries still does not work the way one would wish,
+  % but at least they do not bomb out when the aux file is read in.
+  \catcode`\\=\other
+  %
+  % @ is our escape character in .aux files.
   \catcode`\{=1
   \catcode`\}=2
   \catcode`\ =0
-}
-
-\def\readdatafile#1{%
-\begingroup
-  \setupdatafile
-  \input\jobname.#1
+  %
+  \openin 1 \jobname.aux
+  \ifeof 1 \else
+    \closein 1
+    \input \jobname.aux
+    \global\havexrefstrue
+  \fi
+  % Open the new aux file.  TeX will close it automatically at exit.
+  \openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
 \endgroup}
 
 
-\message{insertions,}
-% including footnotes.
+% Footnotes.
 
 \newcount \footnoteno
 
@@ -7250,6 +6168,8 @@
 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
 \let\footnotestyle=\comment
 
+\let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
+
 {\catcode `\ =11
 %
 % Auto-number footnotes.  Otherwise like plain.
@@ -7273,12 +6193,17 @@
 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
 % footnote text as a parameter.  Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
 %
-% Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
-% \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
+% Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset and anything else that uses
+% \parseargline fail inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
 % the footnote is read.  --karl, 16nov96.
 %
+% The start of the footnote looks usually like this:
+\gdef\startfootins{\insert\footins\bgroup}
+%
+% ... but this macro is redefined inside @multitable.
+%
 \gdef\dofootnote{%
-  \insert\footins\bgroup
+  \startfootins
   % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
   % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
   % So reset some parameters.
@@ -7314,66 +6239,40 @@
 }
 }%end \catcode `\ =11
 
-% In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
-% the real \insert just after the vbox finished.  Otherwise, the insertion
-% would be lost.
-% Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
-% text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
-% And the same can be done for other insert classes.  --kasal, 16nov03.
-
-% Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
-% Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
-% out prematurely.
-%
-\def\startsavinginserts{%
-  \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
-    \let\insert\saveinsert
-  \else
-    \let\checkinserts\relax
-  \fi
-}
-
-% This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
-% \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
+% @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line.  It should
+% surround any changed text.  This approach does *not* work if the
+% change spans more than two lines of output.  To handle that, we would
+% have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
+% vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
 %
-\def\saveinsert#1{%
-  \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
-  \afterassignment\next
-  % swallow the left brace
-  \let\temp =
-}
-\def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
-\def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
-
-\def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
-
-\def\placesaveins#1{%
-  \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
-    {\box#1}%
-}
-
-% eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
-{
-  \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials  %  ;-)
-  \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
-}
-
-% initialization:
-\def\newsaveins #1{%
-  \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
-  \next
-}
-\def\newsaveinsX #1{%
-  \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
-  \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
-    \checksaveins #1}%
+\def\|{%
+  % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
+  \leavevmode
+  %
+  % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
+  \vadjust{%
+    % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
+    % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
+    \vskip-\baselineskip
+    %
+    % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type.  So
+    % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
+    \llap{%
+      %
+      % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
+      \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
+      %
+      % This is the space between the bar and the text.
+      \hskip 12pt
+    }%
+  }%
 }
 
-% initialize:
-\let\checkinserts\empty
-\newsaveins\footins
-\newsaveins\margin
-
+% For a final copy, take out the rectangles
+% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
+% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
+%
+\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
 
 % @image.  We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
@@ -7383,12 +6282,12 @@
 % undone and the next image would fail.
 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
 \ifeof 1 \else
+  \closein 1
   % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
   % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
   \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
   \input epsf.tex
 \fi
-\closein 1
 %
 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
@@ -7427,7 +6326,7 @@
     % above and below.
     \nobreak\vskip\parskip
     \nobreak
-    \line\bgroup
+    \line\bgroup\hss
   \fi
   %
   % Output the image.
@@ -7440,1140 +6339,45 @@
     \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
   \fi
   %
-  \ifimagevmode \egroup \bigbreak \fi  % space after the image
+  \ifimagevmode \hss \egroup \bigbreak \fi  % space after the image
 \endgroup}
 
 
-% @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
-% etc.  We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
-% float "here".  But it seemed the best name for the future.
-%
-\envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
-
-% There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
-\def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
-
-% #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
-% "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc.  Can't contain commas.  If omitted,
-% this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
-%
-% #2 is the optional xref label.  Also must be present for the float to
-% be referable.
-%
-% #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored.  It
-% will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
-%
-% We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
-% chapter-level command.
-\let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
-%
-\def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
-  \let\thiscaption=\empty
-  \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
-  %
-  % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
-  %
-  % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
-  % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
-  %
-  \startsavinginserts
-  %
-  % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
-  \par
-  %
-  \vtop\bgroup
-    \def\floattype{#1}%
-    \def\floatlabel{#2}%
-    \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
-    %
-    \ifx\floattype\empty
-      \let\safefloattype=\empty
-    \else
-      {%
-        % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
-        % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
-        \indexnofonts
-        \turnoffactive
-        \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
-      }%
-    \fi
-    %
-    % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
-    \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
-      % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
-      % Table 1, Figure 2, ...).  (And if no label, no number.)
-      %
-      \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
-      \global\advance\floatno by 1
-      %
-      {%
-        % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
-        % XREFLABEL-title value.  \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
-        % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
-        % node and anchor labels.  And \xrdef uses it to construct the
-        % lists of floats.
-        %
-        \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
-        \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
-      }%
-    \fi
-    %
-    % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
-    \vskip\parskip
-    %
-    % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
-    \restorefirstparagraphindent
-}
-
-% we have these possibilities:
-% @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
-% @float Foo,lbl & no caption:    Foo 1.1
-% @float Foo & @caption{Cap}:     Foo: Cap
-% @float Foo & no caption:        Foo
-% @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}:     1.1: Cap
-% @float ,lbl & no caption:       1.1
-% @float & @caption{Cap}:         Cap
-% @float & no caption:
-%
-\def\Efloat{%
-    \let\floatident = \empty
-    %
-    % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
-    \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
-    %
-    % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
-    \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
-      \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
-        \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
-      \fi
-      % the number.
-      \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
-    \fi
-    %
-    % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
-    % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
-    \let\captionline = \floatident
-    %
-    \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
-      \ifx\floatident\empty \else
-	\appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
-      \fi
-      %
-      % caption text.
-      \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
-    \fi
-    %
-    % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
-    % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
-    \ifx\captionline\empty \else
-      \vskip.5\parskip
-      \captionline
-      %
-      % Space below caption.
-      \vskip\parskip
-    \fi
-    %
-    % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info.  Do this
-    % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
-    \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
-      % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
-      % \floatlabel-lof.  Besides \floatident, we include the short
-      % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
-      {%
-        \atdummies
-        %
-        % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
-        % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
-        % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
-	\scanexp{%
-	  \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
-	    \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
-	      \thiscaption
-	    \else
-	      \thisshortcaption
-	    \fi
-	  }%
-	}%
-        \immediate\write\auxfile{ xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
-	  \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
-      }%
-    \fi
-  \egroup  % end of \vtop
-  %
-  % place the captured inserts
-  %
-  % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
-  % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
-  % float. --kasal, 26may04
-  %
-  \checkinserts
-}
-
-% Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
-%
-\def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
-  \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
-}
-
-% @caption, @shortcaption
-%
-\def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
-\def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
-\def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
-\def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
-
-% The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
-% going to use.  Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
-\def\getfloatno#1{%
-  \ifx#1\relax
-      % Haven't seen this figure type before.
-      \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
-      %
-      % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
-      \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
-        \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
-  \fi
-  \let\floatno#1%
-}
-
-% \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value.  We want an @xref
-% to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1".  We call \setref when we
-% first read the @float command.
-%
-\def\Yfloat{\floattype tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
-
-% Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
-% distinguish floats from other xref types.
-\def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
-
-% #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
-% which is true if #1 represents a float ref.  That is, the magic
-% \lastsection value which we \setref above.
-%
-\def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
-%
-% #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string.  If so, #2 will be the
-% (safe) float type for this float.  We set \iffloattype to #2.
-%
-\def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
-  \def\temp{#1}%
-  \def\iffloattype{#2}%
-  \ifx\temp\floatmagic
-}
-
-% @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
-%
-\parseargdef\listoffloats{%
-  \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
-  {%
-    % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
-    % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
-    \indexnofonts
-    \turnoffactive
-    \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
-  }%
-  %
-  % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
-  \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
-    \ifhavexrefs
-      % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
-      \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
-    \fi
-  \else
-    \begingroup
-      \leftskip=\tocindent  % indent these entries like a toc
-      \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
-      \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
-    \endgroup
-  \fi
-}
-
-% This is called on each entry in a list of floats.  We're passed the
-% xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
-% aux file.  We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
-% has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
-%
-% Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
-% they won't appear in the aux file).
-%
-\def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
-\def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
-  % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything.  Just
-  % pass the control sequence.  On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
-  % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
-  % in pdf output.
-  \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
-  %
-  % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
-  \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
-  \writeentry
-}}
-
-
 \message{localization,}
+% and i18n.
 
 % @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after
 % @setfilename.  If done too late, it may not override everything
-% properly.  Single argument is the language (de) or locale (de_DE)
-% abbreviation.  It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file.
+% properly.  Single argument is the language abbreviation.
+% It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here.
 %
-{
-  \catcode`\_ = \active
-  \globaldefs=1
-\parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup
-  \let_=\normalunderscore  % normal _ character for filenames
+\def\documentlanguage{\parsearg\dodocumentlanguage}
+\def\dodocumentlanguage#1{%
   \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
-    % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
-    \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
-    \ifeof 1
-      \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_\finish}%
-    \else
-      \input txi-#1.tex
-    \fi
-    \closein 1
-  \endgroup
-\endgroup}
-}
-%
-% If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
-% try txi-de.tex.
-% 
-\def\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
+  % Read the file if it exists.
   \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
-  \ifeof 1
+  \ifeof1
     \errhelp = \nolanghelp
     \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
+    \let\temp = \relax
   \else
-    \input txi-#1.tex
+    \def\temp{\input txi-#1.tex }%
   \fi
-  \closein 1
+  \temp
+  \endgroup
 }
-%
 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
 is empty.  Maybe you need to install it?  In the current directory
 should work if nowhere else does.}
 
-% Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
-%
-\def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
-   \count255=128
-   \loop\ifnum\count255<256
-      \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
-      \advance\count255 by 1
-   \repeat
-}
-
-\def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
-   \count255=128
-   \loop\ifnum\count255<256
-      \catcode\count255=#1\relax
-      \advance\count255 by 1
-   \repeat
-}
-
-% @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
-% according to the specified encoding.
-%
-\parseargdef\documentencoding{%
-  % Encoding being declared for the document.
-  \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
-  %
-  % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
-  % to compare them with \ifx.
-  \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
-  \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
-  \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
-  \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
-  \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
-  %
-  \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
-     \asciichardefs
-  %
-  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
-     \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
-     \lattwochardefs
-  %
-  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone 
-     \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
-     \latonechardefs
-  %
-  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
-     \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
-     \latninechardefs
-  %
-  \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
-     \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
-     \utfeightchardefs
-  %
-  \else 
-    \message{Unknown document encoding #1, ignoring.}%
-  %
-  \fi % utfeight
-  \fi % latnine
-  \fi % latone
-  \fi % lattwo
-  \fi % ascii
-}
-
-% A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
-% the default font encoding (OT1).
-% 
-\def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding: #1.}}
-
-% Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
-\def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
-
-% First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
-% correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
-% macros containing the character definitions.
-\setnonasciicharscatcode\active
-%
-% Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
-\def\latonechardefs{%
-  \gdef^^a0{~} 
-  \gdef^^a1{\exclamdown}
-  \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}} 
-  \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}}
-  \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
-  \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}}
-  \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}} 
-  \gdef^^a7{\S}
-  \gdef^^a8{\"{}} 
-  \gdef^^a9{\copyright} 
-  \gdef^^aa{\ordf}
-  \gdef^^ab{\missingcharmsg{LEFT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK}} 
-  \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$}
-  \gdef^^ad{\-} 
-  \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol} 
-  \gdef^^af{\={}}
-  %
-  \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
-  \gdef^^b1{$\pm$}
-  \gdef^^b2{$^2$}
-  \gdef^^b3{$^3$}
-  \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
-  \gdef^^b5{$\mu$}
-  \gdef^^b6{\P}
-  %
-  \gdef^^b7{$^.$}
-  \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
-  \gdef^^b9{$^1$}
-  \gdef^^ba{\ordm}
-  %
-  \gdef^^bb{\missingcharmsg{RIGHT-POINTING DOUBLE ANGLE QUOTATION MARK}}
-  \gdef^^bc{$1\over4$}
-  \gdef^^bd{$1\over2$}
-  \gdef^^be{$3\over4$}
-  \gdef^^bf{\questiondown}
-  %
-  \gdef^^c0{\`A}
-  \gdef^^c1{\'A}
-  \gdef^^c2{\^A}
-  \gdef^^c3{\~A}
-  \gdef^^c4{\"A}
-  \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A} 
-  \gdef^^c6{\AE}
-  \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
-  \gdef^^c8{\`E}
-  \gdef^^c9{\'E}
-  \gdef^^ca{\^E}
-  \gdef^^cb{\"E}
-  \gdef^^cc{\`I}
-  \gdef^^cd{\'I}
-  \gdef^^ce{\^I}
-  \gdef^^cf{\"I}
-  %
-  \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER ETH}}
-  \gdef^^d1{\~N}
-  \gdef^^d2{\`O}
-  \gdef^^d3{\'O}
-  \gdef^^d4{\^O}
-  \gdef^^d5{\~O}
-  \gdef^^d6{\"O}
-  \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
-  \gdef^^d8{\O}
-  \gdef^^d9{\`U}
-  \gdef^^da{\'U}
-  \gdef^^db{\^U}
-  \gdef^^dc{\"U}
-  \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
-  \gdef^^de{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER THORN}}
-  \gdef^^df{\ss}
-  %
-  \gdef^^e0{\`a}
-  \gdef^^e1{\'a}
-  \gdef^^e2{\^a}
-  \gdef^^e3{\~a}
-  \gdef^^e4{\"a}
-  \gdef^^e5{\ringaccent a}
-  \gdef^^e6{\ae}
-  \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
-  \gdef^^e8{\`e}
-  \gdef^^e9{\'e}
-  \gdef^^ea{\^e}
-  \gdef^^eb{\"e}
-  \gdef^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
-  \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
-  \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
-  \gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
-  %
-  \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER ETH}}
-  \gdef^^f1{\~n}
-  \gdef^^f2{\`o}
-  \gdef^^f3{\'o}
-  \gdef^^f4{\^o}
-  \gdef^^f5{\~o}
-  \gdef^^f6{\"o}
-  \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
-  \gdef^^f8{\o}
-  \gdef^^f9{\`u}
-  \gdef^^fa{\'u}
-  \gdef^^fb{\^u}
-  \gdef^^fc{\"u}
-  \gdef^^fd{\'y}
-  \gdef^^fe{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER THORN}}
-  \gdef^^ff{\"y}
-}
-
-% Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
-\def\latninechardefs{%
-  % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
-  \latonechardefs
-  %
-  \gdef^^a4{\euro}
-  \gdef^^a6{\v S}
-  \gdef^^a8{\v s}
-  \gdef^^b4{\v Z}
-  \gdef^^b8{\v z}
-  \gdef^^bc{\OE}
-  \gdef^^bd{\oe}
-  \gdef^^be{\"Y}
-}
-
-% Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
-\def\lattwochardefs{%
-  \gdef^^a0{~}
-  \gdef^^a1{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER A WITH OGONEK}}
-  \gdef^^a2{\u{}}
-  \gdef^^a3{\L}
-  \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
-  \gdef^^a5{\v L}
-  \gdef^^a6{\'S}
-  \gdef^^a7{\S}
-  \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
-  \gdef^^a9{\v S}
-  \gdef^^aa{\cedilla S}
-  \gdef^^ab{\v T}
-  \gdef^^ac{\'Z}
-  \gdef^^ad{\-}
-  \gdef^^ae{\v Z}
-  \gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z}
-  %
-  \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
-  \gdef^^b1{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER A WITH OGONEK}}
-  \gdef^^b2{\missingcharmsg{OGONEK}}
-  \gdef^^b3{\l}
-  \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
-  \gdef^^b5{\v l}
-  \gdef^^b6{\'s}
-  \gdef^^b7{\v{}}
-  \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
-  \gdef^^b9{\v s}
-  \gdef^^ba{\cedilla s}
-  \gdef^^bb{\v t}
-  \gdef^^bc{\'z}
-  \gdef^^bd{\H{}}
-  \gdef^^be{\v z}
-  \gdef^^bf{\dotaccent z}
-  %
-  \gdef^^c0{\'R}
-  \gdef^^c1{\'A}
-  \gdef^^c2{\^A}
-  \gdef^^c3{\u A}
-  \gdef^^c4{\"A}
-  \gdef^^c5{\'L}
-  \gdef^^c6{\'C}
-  \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
-  \gdef^^c8{\v C}
-  \gdef^^c9{\'E}
-  \gdef^^ca{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER E WITH OGONEK}}
-  \gdef^^cb{\"E}
-  \gdef^^cc{\v E}
-  \gdef^^cd{\'I}
-  \gdef^^ce{\^I}
-  \gdef^^cf{\v D}
-  %
-  \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
-  \gdef^^d1{\'N}
-  \gdef^^d2{\v N}
-  \gdef^^d3{\'O}
-  \gdef^^d4{\^O}
-  \gdef^^d5{\H O}
-  \gdef^^d6{\"O}
-  \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
-  \gdef^^d8{\v R}
-  \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U} 
-  \gdef^^da{\'U}
-  \gdef^^db{\H U}
-  \gdef^^dc{\"U}
-  \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
-  \gdef^^de{\cedilla T}
-  \gdef^^df{\ss}
-  %
-  \gdef^^e0{\'r}
-  \gdef^^e1{\'a}
-  \gdef^^e2{\^a}
-  \gdef^^e3{\u a}
-  \gdef^^e4{\"a}
-  \gdef^^e5{\'l}
-  \gdef^^e6{\'c}
-  \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
-  \gdef^^e8{\v c}
-  \gdef^^e9{\'e}
-  \gdef^^ea{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER E WITH OGONEK}}
-  \gdef^^eb{\"e}
-  \gdef^^ec{\v e}
-  \gdef^^ed{\'\i}
-  \gdef^^ee{\^\i}
-  \gdef^^ef{\v d}
-  %
-  \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
-  \gdef^^f1{\'n}
-  \gdef^^f2{\v n}
-  \gdef^^f3{\'o}
-  \gdef^^f4{\^o}
-  \gdef^^f5{\H o}
-  \gdef^^f6{\"o}
-  \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
-  \gdef^^f8{\v r}
-  \gdef^^f9{\ringaccent u}
-  \gdef^^fa{\'u}
-  \gdef^^fb{\H u}
-  \gdef^^fc{\"u}
-  \gdef^^fd{\'y}
-  \gdef^^fe{\cedilla t}
-  \gdef^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
-}
-
-% UTF-8 character definitions.
-% 
-% This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
-% changes for Texinfo conventions.  It is included here under the GPL by
-% permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
-% 
-\newcount\countUTFx
-\newcount\countUTFy
-\newcount\countUTFz
-
-\gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
-   \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
-%
-\gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
-   \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
-%
-\gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
-   \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
-
-\gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
-  \ifx #1\relax
-    \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
-  \else
-    \expandafter #1%
-  \fi
-}
-
-\begingroup
-  \catcode`\~13
-  \catcode`\"12
-
-  \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
-    \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
-    \uccode`\~\countUTFx
-    \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
-    \advance\countUTFx by 1
-    \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
-      \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
-    \fi}
-
-  \countUTFx = "C2
-  \countUTFy = "E0
-  \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
-    \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~}}
-  \UTFviiiLoop
-
-  \countUTFx = "E0
-  \countUTFy = "F0
-  \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
-    \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~}}
-  \UTFviiiLoop
-
-  \countUTFx = "F0
-  \countUTFy = "F4
-  \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
-    \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~}}
-  \UTFviiiLoop
-\endgroup
-
-\begingroup
-  \catcode`\"=12
-  \catcode`\<=12
-  \catcode`\.=12
-  \catcode`\,=12
-  \catcode`\;=12
-  \catcode`\!=12
-  \catcode`\~=13
-
-  \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
-    \countUTFz = "#1\relax
-    \wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
-    \begingroup
-      \parseXMLCharref
-      \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{%
-        \csname u8:##1\string ##2\endcsname}%
-      \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets##1##2##3{%
-        \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\endcsname}%
-      \def\UTFviiiFourOctets##1##2##3##4{%
-        \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\string ##4\endcsname}%
-      \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
-       \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
-       \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
-    \endgroup}
 
-  \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
-    \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
-      \errhelp = \EMsimple
-      \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
-    \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
-      \parseUTFviiiA,%
-      \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,%
-    \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
-      \parseUTFviiiA;%
-      \parseUTFviiiA,%
-      \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctets.{,;}%
-    \else
-      \parseUTFviiiA;%
-      \parseUTFviiiA,%
-      \parseUTFviiiA!%
-      \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctets.{!,;}%
-    \fi\fi\fi
-  }
+% @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most
+% likely, but for now just recognize it.
+\let\documentencoding = \comment
 
-  \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
-    \countUTFx = \countUTFz
-    \divide\countUTFz by 64
-    \countUTFy = \countUTFz
-    \multiply\countUTFz by 64
-    \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
-    \advance\countUTFx by 128
-    \uccode `#1\countUTFx
-    \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
-
-  \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
-    \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
-    \uccode `#3\countUTFz
-    \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
-\endgroup
 
-\def\utfeightchardefs{%
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result}
-
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
-  \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
-}% end of \utfeightchardefs
-
-
-% US-ASCII character definitions.
-\def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
-   \relax
-}
-
-% Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
-% existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
-% document encoding.
+% Page size parameters.
 %
-\setnonasciicharscatcode \other
-
-
-\message{formatting,}
-
 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
 
 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
@@ -8586,7 +6390,7 @@
 % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
 \hbadness = 2000
 
-% Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
+% Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans.
 \widowpenalty=10000
 \clubpenalty=10000
 
@@ -8604,9 +6408,9 @@
   \fi
 }
 
-% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
-% 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
-% 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
+% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; 3) voffset;
+% 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip; 7) physical page height; 8)
+% physical page width.
 %
 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
 % \textleading.  The caller should also set \parskip.
@@ -8633,10 +6437,6 @@
   \ifpdf
     \pdfpageheight #7\relax
     \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
-    % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
-    % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
-    \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
-    \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
   \fi
   %
   \setleading{\textleading}
@@ -8651,19 +6451,19 @@
   \textleading = 13.2pt
   %
   % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
-  \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
+  \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}%
                     {\voffset}{.25in}%
                     {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
                     {11in}{8.5in}%
 }}
 
-% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
+% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 (or so) format.
 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
   \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
   \textleading = 12pt
   %
   \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
-                    {-.2in}{0in}%
+                    {\voffset}{.25in}%
                     {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
                     {9.25in}{7in}%
   %
@@ -8674,24 +6474,6 @@
   \defbodyindent = .5cm
 }}
 
-% Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
-% (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
-\def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
-  \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
-  \textleading = 12pt
-  %
-  \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
-                    {-.2in}{-.4in}%
-                    {0pt}{14pt}%
-                    {9in}{6in}%
-  %
-  \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
-  \tolerance = 700
-  \hfuzz = 1pt
-  \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
-  \defbodyindent = .4cm
-}}
-
 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
   \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
@@ -8707,7 +6489,7 @@
   % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
   % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
   % @end tex
-  \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
+  \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm}
                     {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
                     {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
                     {297mm}{210mm}%
@@ -8764,7 +6546,8 @@
 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
 %
-\parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
+\def\pagesizes{\parsearg\pagesizesxxx}
+\def\pagesizesxxx#1{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
   \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
   \globaldefs = 1
@@ -8772,7 +6555,7 @@
   \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
   \setleading{\textleading}%
   %
-  \dimen0 = #1\relax
+  \dimen0 = #1
   \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
   %
   \dimen2 = \hsize
@@ -8811,8 +6594,8 @@
 \def\normalplus{+}
 \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
 
-% This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
-% (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
+% This macro is used to make a character print one way in ttfont
+% where it can probably just be output, and another way in other fonts,
 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
 %
 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
@@ -8844,7 +6627,6 @@
 
 \catcode`\_=\active
 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
-\let\realunder=_
 % Subroutine for the previous macro.
 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
 
@@ -8861,49 +6643,46 @@
 \catcode`\$=\active
 \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
 
+% Set up an active definition for =, but don't enable it most of the time.
+{\catcode`\==\active
+\global\def={{\tt \char 61}}}
+
+\catcode`+=\active
+\catcode`\_=\active
+
 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
 
-% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
-% parsing them.
-\def\turnoffactive{%
-  \normalturnoffactive
-  \otherbackslash
-}
-
 \catcode`\ =0
 
-% \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
+% \rawbackslashxx outputs one backslash character in current font,
 % as in \char`\\.
-\global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
-\global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont  % let existing .??s files work
+\global\chardef\rawbackslashxx=`\\
 
-% \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
-% \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
-{\catcode`\\=\other @gdef realbackslash{\} @gdef doublebackslash{\\}}
-
-% In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
-% in fixed width font.
-\catcode`\\=\active
- def@normalbackslash{{ tt@backslashcurfont}}
-% On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
-%  @let \ = @normalbackslash
-
-% \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
+% \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \rawbackslashxx.
 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
 % catcode other.
- gdef@rawbackslash{ let\=@backslashcurfont}
- gdef@otherbackslash{ let\=@realbackslash}
+{\catcode`\\=\active
+ @gdef rawbackslash{@let\= rawbackslashxx}
+ @gdef otherbackslash{@let\= realbackslash}
+}
 
-% Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
-% the literal character `\'.
-% 
- def@normalturnoffactive{%
-  @let\= normalbackslash
+% \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other.
+{\catcode`\\=\other @gdef realbackslash{\}}
+
+% \normalbackslash outputs one backslash in fixed width font.
+\def\normalbackslash{{\tt\rawbackslashxx}}
+
+\catcode`\\=\active
+
+% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters
+% even after parsing them.
+ def@turnoffactive{%
   @let"= normaldoublequote
+  @let\= realbackslash
   @let~= normaltilde
   @let^= normalcaret
   @let_= normalunderscore
@@ -8912,9 +6691,14 @@
   @let>= normalgreater
   @let+= normalplus
   @let$= normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
-  @unsepspaces
 }
 
+% Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
+% the literal character `\'.  (Thus, \ is not expandable when this is in
+% effect.)
+%
+ def@normalturnoffactive{ turnoffactive @let\= normalbackslash}
+
 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
 @otherifyactive
@@ -8927,9 +6711,9 @@
 @global let\ = @eatinput
 
 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
-% the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
+% the first `\{ in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
-% Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
+% Also back turn on active characters that might appear in the input
 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
 %
 @gdef fixbackslash{%
@@ -8946,6 +6730,10 @@
 @catcode` # = @other
 @catcode` % = @other
 
+ c Set initial fonts.
+ textfonts
+ rm
+
 
 @c Local variables:
 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
@@ -8954,9 +6742,3 @@
 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
 @c time-stamp-end: "}"
 @c End:
-
- c vim:sw=2:
-
- ignore
-   arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
- end ignore

Modified: branches/gcomprixogoo/install-sh
==============================================================================
--- branches/gcomprixogoo/install-sh	(original)
+++ branches/gcomprixogoo/install-sh	Mon Oct 27 21:00:29 2008
@@ -1,8 +1,7 @@
 #!/bin/sh
+#
 # install - install a program, script, or datafile
-
-scriptversion=2006-12-25.00
-
+#
 # This originates from X11R5 (mit/util/scripts/install.sh), which was
 # later released in X11R6 (xc/config/util/install.sh) with the
 # following copyright and license.
@@ -39,481 +38,257 @@
 # when there is no Makefile.
 #
 # This script is compatible with the BSD install script, but was written
-# from scratch.
+# from scratch.  It can only install one file at a time, a restriction
+# shared with many OS's install programs.
 
-nl='
-'
-IFS=" ""	$nl"
 
 # set DOITPROG to echo to test this script
 
 # Don't use :- since 4.3BSD and earlier shells don't like it.
-doit=${DOITPROG-}
-if test -z "$doit"; then
-  doit_exec=exec
-else
-  doit_exec=$doit
-fi
+doit="${DOITPROG-}"
 
-# Put in absolute file names if you don't have them in your path;
-# or use environment vars.
 
-chgrpprog=${CHGRPPROG-chgrp}
-chmodprog=${CHMODPROG-chmod}
-chownprog=${CHOWNPROG-chown}
-cmpprog=${CMPPROG-cmp}
-cpprog=${CPPROG-cp}
-mkdirprog=${MKDIRPROG-mkdir}
-mvprog=${MVPROG-mv}
-rmprog=${RMPROG-rm}
-stripprog=${STRIPPROG-strip}
-
-posix_glob='?'
-initialize_posix_glob='
-  test "$posix_glob" != "?" || {
-    if (set -f) 2>/dev/null; then
-      posix_glob=
-    else
-      posix_glob=:
-    fi
-  }
-'
-
-posix_mkdir=
-
-# Desired mode of installed file.
-mode=0755
-
-chgrpcmd=
-chmodcmd=$chmodprog
-chowncmd=
-mvcmd=$mvprog
+# put in absolute paths if you don't have them in your path; or use env. vars.
+
+mvprog="${MVPROG-mv}"
+cpprog="${CPPROG-cp}"
+chmodprog="${CHMODPROG-chmod}"
+chownprog="${CHOWNPROG-chown}"
+chgrpprog="${CHGRPPROG-chgrp}"
+stripprog="${STRIPPROG-strip}"
+rmprog="${RMPROG-rm}"
+mkdirprog="${MKDIRPROG-mkdir}"
+
+transformbasename=""
+transform_arg=""
+instcmd="$mvprog"
+chmodcmd="$chmodprog 0755"
+chowncmd=""
+chgrpcmd=""
+stripcmd=""
 rmcmd="$rmprog -f"
-stripcmd=
+mvcmd="$mvprog"
+src=""
+dst=""
+dir_arg=""
+
+while [ x"$1" != x ]; do
+    case $1 in
+	-c) instcmd=$cpprog
+	    shift
+	    continue;;
+
+	-d) dir_arg=true
+	    shift
+	    continue;;
+
+	-m) chmodcmd="$chmodprog $2"
+	    shift
+	    shift
+	    continue;;
+
+	-o) chowncmd="$chownprog $2"
+	    shift
+	    shift
+	    continue;;
+
+	-g) chgrpcmd="$chgrpprog $2"
+	    shift
+	    shift
+	    continue;;
+
+	-s) stripcmd=$stripprog
+	    shift
+	    continue;;
+
+	-t=*) transformarg=`echo $1 | sed 's/-t=//'`
+	    shift
+	    continue;;
+
+	-b=*) transformbasename=`echo $1 | sed 's/-b=//'`
+	    shift
+	    continue;;
 
-src=
-dst=
-dir_arg=
-dst_arg=
+	*)  if [ x"$src" = x ]
+	    then
+		src=$1
+	    else
+		# this colon is to work around a 386BSD /bin/sh bug
+		:
+		dst=$1
+	    fi
+	    shift
+	    continue;;
+    esac
+done
 
-copy_on_change=false
-no_target_directory=
+if [ x"$src" = x ]
+then
+	echo "$0: no input file specified" >&2
+	exit 1
+else
+	:
+fi
 
-usage="\
-Usage: $0 [OPTION]... [-T] SRCFILE DSTFILE
-   or: $0 [OPTION]... SRCFILES... DIRECTORY
-   or: $0 [OPTION]... -t DIRECTORY SRCFILES...
-   or: $0 [OPTION]... -d DIRECTORIES...
+if [ x"$dir_arg" != x ]; then
+	dst=$src
+	src=""
+
+	if [ -d "$dst" ]; then
+		instcmd=:
+		chmodcmd=""
+	else
+		instcmd=$mkdirprog
+	fi
+else
 
-In the 1st form, copy SRCFILE to DSTFILE.
-In the 2nd and 3rd, copy all SRCFILES to DIRECTORY.
-In the 4th, create DIRECTORIES.
+# Waiting for this to be detected by the "$instcmd $src $dsttmp" command
+# might cause directories to be created, which would be especially bad
+# if $src (and thus $dsttmp) contains '*'.
+
+	if [ -f "$src" ] || [ -d "$src" ]
+	then
+		:
+	else
+		echo "$0: $src does not exist" >&2
+		exit 1
+	fi
 
-Options:
-     --help     display this help and exit.
-     --version  display version info and exit.
+	if [ x"$dst" = x ]
+	then
+		echo "$0: no destination specified" >&2
+		exit 1
+	else
+		:
+	fi
 
-  -c            (ignored)
-  -C            install only if different (preserve the last data modification time)
-  -d            create directories instead of installing files.
-  -g GROUP      $chgrpprog installed files to GROUP.
-  -m MODE       $chmodprog installed files to MODE.
-  -o USER       $chownprog installed files to USER.
-  -s            $stripprog installed files.
-  -t DIRECTORY  install into DIRECTORY.
-  -T            report an error if DSTFILE is a directory.
+# If destination is a directory, append the input filename; if your system
+# does not like double slashes in filenames, you may need to add some logic
 
-Environment variables override the default commands:
-  CHGRPPROG CHMODPROG CHOWNPROG CMPPROG CPPROG MKDIRPROG MVPROG
-  RMPROG STRIPPROG
-"
+	if [ -d "$dst" ]
+	then
+		dst=$dst/`basename "$src"`
+	else
+		:
+	fi
+fi
 
-while test $# -ne 0; do
-  case $1 in
-    -c) ;;
+## this sed command emulates the dirname command
+dstdir=`echo "$dst" | sed -e 's,[^/]*$,,;s,/$,,;s,^$,.,'`
 
-    -C) copy_on_change=true;;
+# Make sure that the destination directory exists.
+#  this part is taken from Noah Friedman's mkinstalldirs script
 
-    -d) dir_arg=true;;
+# Skip lots of stat calls in the usual case.
+if [ ! -d "$dstdir" ]; then
+defaultIFS='
+	'
+IFS="${IFS-$defaultIFS}"
+
+oIFS=$IFS
+# Some sh's can't handle IFS=/ for some reason.
+IFS='%'
+set - `echo "$dstdir" | sed -e 's@/@% g' -e 's ^%@/@'`
+IFS=$oIFS
+
+pathcomp=''
+
+while [ $# -ne 0 ] ; do
+	pathcomp=$pathcomp$1
+	shift
+
+	if [ ! -d "$pathcomp" ] ;
+        then
+		$mkdirprog "$pathcomp"
+	else
+		:
+	fi
 
-    -g) chgrpcmd="$chgrpprog $2"
-	shift;;
+	pathcomp=$pathcomp/
+done
+fi
 
-    --help) echo "$usage"; exit $?;;
+if [ x"$dir_arg" != x ]
+then
+	$doit $instcmd "$dst" &&
+
+	if [ x"$chowncmd" != x ]; then $doit $chowncmd "$dst"; else : ; fi &&
+	if [ x"$chgrpcmd" != x ]; then $doit $chgrpcmd "$dst"; else : ; fi &&
+	if [ x"$stripcmd" != x ]; then $doit $stripcmd "$dst"; else : ; fi &&
+	if [ x"$chmodcmd" != x ]; then $doit $chmodcmd "$dst"; else : ; fi
+else
 
-    -m) mode=$2
-	case $mode in
-	  *' '* | *'	'* | *'
-'*	  | *'*'* | *'?'* | *'['*)
-	    echo "$0: invalid mode: $mode" >&2
-	    exit 1;;
-	esac
-	shift;;
+# If we're going to rename the final executable, determine the name now.
 
-    -o) chowncmd="$chownprog $2"
-	shift;;
+	if [ x"$transformarg" = x ]
+	then
+		dstfile=`basename "$dst"`
+	else
+		dstfile=`basename "$dst" $transformbasename |
+			sed $transformarg`$transformbasename
+	fi
 
-    -s) stripcmd=$stripprog;;
+# don't allow the sed command to completely eliminate the filename
 
-    -t) dst_arg=$2
-	shift;;
+	if [ x"$dstfile" = x ]
+	then
+		dstfile=`basename "$dst"`
+	else
+		:
+	fi
 
-    -T) no_target_directory=true;;
+# Make a couple of temp file names in the proper directory.
 
-    --version) echo "$0 $scriptversion"; exit $?;;
+	dsttmp=$dstdir/_inst.$$_
+	rmtmp=$dstdir/_rm.$$_
 
-    --)	shift
-	break;;
+# Trap to clean up temp files at exit.
 
-    -*)	echo "$0: invalid option: $1" >&2
-	exit 1;;
+	trap 'status=$?; rm -f "$dsttmp" "$rmtmp" && exit $status' 0
+	trap '(exit $?); exit' 1 2 13 15
 
-    *)  break;;
-  esac
-  shift
-done
+# Move or copy the file name to the temp name
 
-if test $# -ne 0 && test -z "$dir_arg$dst_arg"; then
-  # When -d is used, all remaining arguments are directories to create.
-  # When -t is used, the destination is already specified.
-  # Otherwise, the last argument is the destination.  Remove it from $  
-  for arg
-  do
-    if test -n "$dst_arg"; then
-      # $@ is not empty: it contains at least $arg.
-      set fnord "$@" "$dst_arg"
-      shift # fnord
-    fi
-    shift # arg
-    dst_arg=$arg
-  done
-fi
+	$doit $instcmd "$src" "$dsttmp" &&
 
-if test $# -eq 0; then
-  if test -z "$dir_arg"; then
-    echo "$0: no input file specified." >&2
-    exit 1
-  fi
-  # It's OK to call `install-sh -d' without argument.
-  # This can happen when creating conditional directories.
-  exit 0
-fi
+# and set any options; do chmod last to preserve setuid bits
 
-if test -z "$dir_arg"; then
-  trap '(exit $?); exit' 1 2 13 15
+# If any of these fail, we abort the whole thing.  If we want to
+# ignore errors from any of these, just make sure not to ignore
+# errors from the above "$doit $instcmd $src $dsttmp" command.
 
-  # Set umask so as not to create temps with too-generous modes.
-  # However, 'strip' requires both read and write access to temps.
-  case $mode in
-    # Optimize common cases.
-    *644) cp_umask=133;;
-    *755) cp_umask=22;;
-
-    *[0-7])
-      if test -z "$stripcmd"; then
-	u_plus_rw=
-      else
-	u_plus_rw='% 200'
-      fi
-      cp_umask=`expr '(' 777 - $mode % 1000 ')' $u_plus_rw`;;
-    *)
-      if test -z "$stripcmd"; then
-	u_plus_rw=
-      else
-	u_plus_rw=,u+rw
-      fi
-      cp_umask=$mode$u_plus_rw;;
-  esac
-fi
+	if [ x"$chowncmd" != x ]; then $doit $chowncmd "$dsttmp"; else :;fi &&
+	if [ x"$chgrpcmd" != x ]; then $doit $chgrpcmd "$dsttmp"; else :;fi &&
+	if [ x"$stripcmd" != x ]; then $doit $stripcmd "$dsttmp"; else :;fi &&
+	if [ x"$chmodcmd" != x ]; then $doit $chmodcmd "$dsttmp"; else :;fi &&
 
-for src
-do
-  # Protect names starting with `-'.
-  case $src in
-    -*) src=./$src;;
-  esac
-
-  if test -n "$dir_arg"; then
-    dst=$src
-    dstdir=$dst
-    test -d "$dstdir"
-    dstdir_status=$?
-  else
-
-    # Waiting for this to be detected by the "$cpprog $src $dsttmp" command
-    # might cause directories to be created, which would be especially bad
-    # if $src (and thus $dsttmp) contains '*'.
-    if test ! -f "$src" && test ! -d "$src"; then
-      echo "$0: $src does not exist." >&2
-      exit 1
-    fi
-
-    if test -z "$dst_arg"; then
-      echo "$0: no destination specified." >&2
-      exit 1
-    fi
-
-    dst=$dst_arg
-    # Protect names starting with `-'.
-    case $dst in
-      -*) dst=./$dst;;
-    esac
+# Now remove or move aside any old file at destination location.  We try this
+# two ways since rm can't unlink itself on some systems and the destination
+# file might be busy for other reasons.  In this case, the final cleanup
+# might fail but the new file should still install successfully.
 
-    # If destination is a directory, append the input filename; won't work
-    # if double slashes aren't ignored.
-    if test -d "$dst"; then
-      if test -n "$no_target_directory"; then
-	echo "$0: $dst_arg: Is a directory" >&2
-	exit 1
-      fi
-      dstdir=$dst
-      dst=$dstdir/`basename "$src"`
-      dstdir_status=0
-    else
-      # Prefer dirname, but fall back on a substitute if dirname fails.
-      dstdir=`
-	(dirname "$dst") 2>/dev/null ||
-	expr X"$dst" : 'X\(.*[^/]\)//*[^/][^/]*/*$' \| \
-	     X"$dst" : 'X\(//\)[^/]' \| \
-	     X"$dst" : 'X\(//\)$' \| \
-	     X"$dst" : 'X\(/\)' \| . 2>/dev/null ||
-	echo X"$dst" |
-	    sed '/^X\(.*[^/]\)\/\/*[^/][^/]*\/*$/{
-		   s//\1/
-		   q
-		 }
-		 /^X\(\/\/\)[^/].*/{
-		   s//\1/
-		   q
-		 }
-		 /^X\(\/\/\)$/{
-		   s//\1/
-		   q
-		 }
-		 /^X\(\/\).*/{
-		   s//\1/
-		   q
-		 }
-		 s/.*/./; q'
-      `
-
-      test -d "$dstdir"
-      dstdir_status=$?
-    fi
-  fi
-
-  obsolete_mkdir_used=false
-
-  if test $dstdir_status != 0; then
-    case $posix_mkdir in
-      '')
-	# Create intermediate dirs using mode 755 as modified by the umask.
-	# This is like FreeBSD 'install' as of 1997-10-28.
-	umask=`umask`
-	case $stripcmd.$umask in
-	  # Optimize common cases.
-	  *[2367][2367]) mkdir_umask=$umask;;
-	  .*0[02][02] | .[02][02] | .[02]) mkdir_umask=22;;
-
-	  *[0-7])
-	    mkdir_umask=`expr $umask + 22 \
-	      - $umask % 100 % 40 + $umask % 20 \
-	      - $umask % 10 % 4 + $umask % 2
-	    `;;
-	  *) mkdir_umask=$umask,go-w;;
-	esac
-
-	# With -d, create the new directory with the user-specified mode.
-	# Otherwise, rely on $mkdir_umask.
-	if test -n "$dir_arg"; then
-	  mkdir_mode=-m$mode
+{
+	if [ -f "$dstdir/$dstfile" ]
+	then
+		$doit $rmcmd -f "$dstdir/$dstfile" 2>/dev/null ||
+		$doit $mvcmd -f "$dstdir/$dstfile" "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null ||
+		{
+		  echo "$0: cannot unlink or rename $dstdir/$dstfile" >&2
+		  (exit 1); exit
+		}
 	else
-	  mkdir_mode=
+		:
 	fi
+} &&
 
-	posix_mkdir=false
-	case $umask in
-	  *[123567][0-7][0-7])
-	    # POSIX mkdir -p sets u+wx bits regardless of umask, which
-	    # is incompatible with FreeBSD 'install' when (umask & 300) != 0.
-	    ;;
-	  *)
-	    tmpdir=${TMPDIR-/tmp}/ins$RANDOM-$$
-	    trap 'ret=$?; rmdir "$tmpdir/d" "$tmpdir" 2>/dev/null; exit $ret' 0
-
-	    if (umask $mkdir_umask &&
-		exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$tmpdir/d") >/dev/null 2>&1
-	    then
-	      if test -z "$dir_arg" || {
-		   # Check for POSIX incompatibilities with -m.
-		   # HP-UX 11.23 and IRIX 6.5 mkdir -m -p sets group- or
-		   # other-writeable bit of parent directory when it shouldn't.
-		   # FreeBSD 6.1 mkdir -m -p sets mode of existing directory.
-		   ls_ld_tmpdir=`ls -ld "$tmpdir"`
-		   case $ls_ld_tmpdir in
-		     d????-?r-*) different_mode=700;;
-		     d????-?--*) different_mode=755;;
-		     *) false;;
-		   esac &&
-		   $mkdirprog -m$different_mode -p -- "$tmpdir" && {
-		     ls_ld_tmpdir_1=`ls -ld "$tmpdir"`
-		     test "$ls_ld_tmpdir" = "$ls_ld_tmpdir_1"
-		   }
-		 }
-	      then posix_mkdir=:
-	      fi
-	      rmdir "$tmpdir/d" "$tmpdir"
-	    else
-	      # Remove any dirs left behind by ancient mkdir implementations.
-	      rmdir ./$mkdir_mode ./-p ./-- 2>/dev/null
-	    fi
-	    trap '' 0;;
-	esac;;
-    esac
+# Now rename the file to the real destination.
 
-    if
-      $posix_mkdir && (
-	umask $mkdir_umask &&
-	$doit_exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$dstdir"
-      )
-    then :
-    else
-
-      # The umask is ridiculous, or mkdir does not conform to POSIX,
-      # or it failed possibly due to a race condition.  Create the
-      # directory the slow way, step by step, checking for races as we go.
-
-      case $dstdir in
-	/*) prefix='/';;
-	-*) prefix='./';;
-	*)  prefix='';;
-      esac
-
-      eval "$initialize_posix_glob"
-
-      oIFS=$IFS
-      IFS=/
-      $posix_glob set -f
-      set fnord $dstdir
-      shift
-      $posix_glob set +f
-      IFS=$oIFS
-
-      prefixes=
-
-      for d
-      do
-	test -z "$d" && continue
-
-	prefix=$prefix$d
-	if test -d "$prefix"; then
-	  prefixes=
-	else
-	  if $posix_mkdir; then
-	    (umask=$mkdir_umask &&
-	     $doit_exec $mkdirprog $mkdir_mode -p -- "$dstdir") && break
-	    # Don't fail if two instances are running concurrently.
-	    test -d "$prefix" || exit 1
-	  else
-	    case $prefix in
-	      *\'*) qprefix=`echo "$prefix" | sed "s/'/'\\\\\\\\''/g"`;;
-	      *) qprefix=$prefix;;
-	    esac
-	    prefixes="$prefixes '$qprefix'"
-	  fi
-	fi
-	prefix=$prefix/
-      done
+	$doit $mvcmd "$dsttmp" "$dstdir/$dstfile"
 
-      if test -n "$prefixes"; then
-	# Don't fail if two instances are running concurrently.
-	(umask $mkdir_umask &&
-	 eval "\$doit_exec \$mkdirprog $prefixes") ||
-	  test -d "$dstdir" || exit 1
-	obsolete_mkdir_used=true
-      fi
-    fi
-  fi
-
-  if test -n "$dir_arg"; then
-    { test -z "$chowncmd" || $doit $chowncmd "$dst"; } &&
-    { test -z "$chgrpcmd" || $doit $chgrpcmd "$dst"; } &&
-    { test "$obsolete_mkdir_used$chowncmd$chgrpcmd" = false ||
-      test -z "$chmodcmd" || $doit $chmodcmd $mode "$dst"; } || exit 1
-  else
-
-    # Make a couple of temp file names in the proper directory.
-    dsttmp=$dstdir/_inst.$$_
-    rmtmp=$dstdir/_rm.$$_
-
-    # Trap to clean up those temp files at exit.
-    trap 'ret=$?; rm -f "$dsttmp" "$rmtmp" && exit $ret' 0
-
-    # Copy the file name to the temp name.
-    (umask $cp_umask && $doit_exec $cpprog "$src" "$dsttmp") &&
-
-    # and set any options; do chmod last to preserve setuid bits.
-    #
-    # If any of these fail, we abort the whole thing.  If we want to
-    # ignore errors from any of these, just make sure not to ignore
-    # errors from the above "$doit $cpprog $src $dsttmp" command.
-    #
-    { test -z "$chowncmd" || $doit $chowncmd "$dsttmp"; } &&
-    { test -z "$chgrpcmd" || $doit $chgrpcmd "$dsttmp"; } &&
-    { test -z "$stripcmd" || $doit $stripcmd "$dsttmp"; } &&
-    { test -z "$chmodcmd" || $doit $chmodcmd $mode "$dsttmp"; } &&
-
-    # If -C, don't bother to copy if it wouldn't change the file.
-    if $copy_on_change &&
-       old=`LC_ALL=C ls -dlL "$dst"	2>/dev/null` &&
-       new=`LC_ALL=C ls -dlL "$dsttmp"	2>/dev/null` &&
-
-       eval "$initialize_posix_glob" &&
-       $posix_glob set -f &&
-       set X $old && old=:$2:$4:$5:$6 &&
-       set X $new && new=:$2:$4:$5:$6 &&
-       $posix_glob set +f &&
-
-       test "$old" = "$new" &&
-       $cmpprog "$dst" "$dsttmp" >/dev/null 2>&1
-    then
-      rm -f "$dsttmp"
-    else
-      # Rename the file to the real destination.
-      $doit $mvcmd -f "$dsttmp" "$dst" 2>/dev/null ||
-
-      # The rename failed, perhaps because mv can't rename something else
-      # to itself, or perhaps because mv is so ancient that it does not
-      # support -f.
-      {
-	# Now remove or move aside any old file at destination location.
-	# We try this two ways since rm can't unlink itself on some
-	# systems and the destination file might be busy for other
-	# reasons.  In this case, the final cleanup might fail but the new
-	# file should still install successfully.
-	{
-	  test ! -f "$dst" ||
-	  $doit $rmcmd -f "$dst" 2>/dev/null ||
-	  { $doit $mvcmd -f "$dst" "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null &&
-	    { $doit $rmcmd -f "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null; :; }
-	  } ||
-	  { echo "$0: cannot unlink or rename $dst" >&2
-	    (exit 1); exit 1
-	  }
-	} &&
-
-	# Now rename the file to the real destination.
-	$doit $mvcmd "$dsttmp" "$dst"
-      }
-    fi || exit 1
+fi &&
 
-    trap '' 0
-  fi
-done
+# The final little trick to "correctly" pass the exit status to the exit trap.
 
-# Local variables:
-# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
-# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
-# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
-# time-stamp-end: "$"
-# End:
+{
+	(exit 0); exit
+}

Modified: branches/gcomprixogoo/src/administration-activity/admin/module.py
==============================================================================
--- branches/gcomprixogoo/src/administration-activity/admin/module.py	(original)
+++ branches/gcomprixogoo/src/administration-activity/admin/module.py	Mon Oct 27 21:00:29 2008
@@ -61,7 +61,7 @@
             parent = self.root_select_item,
             x = select_area[0]+2,
             y = y1,
-            width = select_area[2]-2 - select_area[0]+2,
+            width = select_area[2] - select_area[0] - 4,
             height = y2 - y1,
             fill_color="white",
             stroke_color="white",

Modified: branches/gcomprixogoo/src/administration-activity/administration.py
==============================================================================
--- branches/gcomprixogoo/src/administration-activity/administration.py	(original)
+++ branches/gcomprixogoo/src/administration-activity/administration.py	Mon Oct 27 21:00:29 2008
@@ -41,13 +41,14 @@
     # only have to kill it. The canvas deletes all the items it contains automaticaly.
     self.rootitem = goocanvas.Group(parent =  self.gcomprisBoard.canvas.get_root_item())
 
-    gap = 10
+    gapx = 6
+    gapy = 10
     panel_x = 120
-    self.select_area = (gap , gap, panel_x + gap , gcompris.BOARD_HEIGHT-gap)
-    self.panel_area  = (panel_x + 2*gap ,
-                        gap,
-                        gcompris.BOARD_WIDTH-gap,
-                        gcompris.BOARD_HEIGHT-gap)
+    self.select_area = (gapx, gapy, panel_x + gapx , gcompris.BOARD_HEIGHT-gapy)
+    self.panel_area  = (panel_x + 2*gapx ,
+                        gapy,
+                        gcompris.BOARD_WIDTH-gapx,
+                        gcompris.BOARD_HEIGHT-gapy)
 
 
 
@@ -95,6 +96,7 @@
     gcompris.set_background(self.gcomprisBoard.canvas.get_root_item(),
                             gcompris.skin.image_to_skin("gcompris-bg.jpg"))
     gcompris.bar_set_level(self.gcomprisBoard)
+    gcompris.bar_location(25, -1, 0.6)
 
     goocanvas.Rect(
       parent = self.rootitem,

Modified: branches/gcomprixogoo/src/boards/py-mod-gcompris.c
==============================================================================
--- branches/gcomprixogoo/src/boards/py-mod-gcompris.c	(original)
+++ branches/gcomprixogoo/src/boards/py-mod-gcompris.c	Mon Oct 27 21:00:29 2008
@@ -230,6 +230,27 @@
   return Py_None;
 }
 
+/* void gc_bar_location (int x, int y, double zoom); */
+static PyObject*
+py_gc_bar_location(PyObject* self, PyObject* args)
+{
+  gint x;
+  gint y;
+  double zoom;
+
+  /* Parse arguments */
+  if(!PyArg_ParseTuple(args, "iid:gc_bar_location",
+                       &x, &y, &zoom))
+    return NULL;
+
+  /* Call the corresponding C function */
+  gc_bar_location(x, y, zoom);
+
+  /* Create and return the result */
+  Py_INCREF(Py_None);
+  return Py_None;
+}
+
 /* GooCanvas *gc_get_canvas(void); */
 static PyObject*
 py_gc_get_canvas(PyObject* self, PyObject* args)
@@ -1495,6 +1516,7 @@
   { "bar_set_repeat_icon",  py_gc_bar_set_repeat_icon, METH_VARARGS, "gc_bar_set_repeat_icon" },
   { "bar_set",  py_gc_bar_set, METH_VARARGS, "gc_bar_set" },
   { "bar_hide",  py_gc_bar_hide, METH_VARARGS, "gc_bar_hide" },
+  { "bar_location",  py_gc_bar_location, METH_VARARGS, "gc_bar_location" },
   { "get_canvas",  py_gc_get_canvas, METH_VARARGS, "gc_get_canvas" },
   { "get_window",  py_gc_get_window, METH_VARARGS, "gc_get_window" },
   { "get_locale",  py_gc_locale_get, METH_VARARGS, "gc_locale_get" },



[Date Prev][Date Next]   [Thread Prev][Thread Next]   [Thread Index] [Date Index] [Author Index]